Toshiba Personal Computer A3X User Manual

1
Toshiba Personal Computer  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Series  
Maintenance Manual  
TOSHIBA CORPORATION  
File Number 960-534  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preface  
This maintenance manual describes how to perform hardware service maintenance for the  
Toshiba Personal Computer Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X series.  
NOTE: This Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X series is a BTO-support personal computer.  
Each model has a different configuration. For each model’s configuration, refer to the  
parts list dedicated to it.  
The procedures described in this manual are intended to help service technicians isolate  
faulty Field Replaceable Units (FRUs) and replace them in the field.  
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS  
Four types of messages are used in this manual to bring important information to your  
attention. Each of these messages will be italicized and identified as shown below.  
DANGER: “Danger” indicates the existence of a hazard that could result in death or  
serious bodily injury, if the safety instruction is not observed.  
WARNING: “Warning” indicates the existence of a hazard that could result in bodily  
injury, if the safety instruction is not observed.  
CAUTION: “Caution” indicates the existence of a hazard that could result in property  
damage, if the safety instruction is not observed.  
NOTE: “Note” contains general information that relates to your safe maintenance  
service.  
Improper repair of the computer may result in safety hazards. Toshiba requires service  
technicians and authorized dealers or service providers to ensure the following safety  
precautions are adhered to strictly.  
Be sure to fasten screws securely with the right screwdriver. Be sure to use the PH  
Point size “0” and “1” screwdrivers complying with the ISO/DIS 8764-1:1996. If a  
screw is not fully fastened, it could come loose, creating a danger of a short circuit,  
which could cause overheating, smoke or fire.  
If you replace the battery pack or RTC battery, be sure to use only the same model  
battery or an equivalent battery recommended by Toshiba. Installation of the wrong  
battery can cause the battery to explode.  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The manual is divided into the following parts:  
Chapter 1  
Chapter 2  
Chapter 3  
Chapter 4  
Hardware Overview describes Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X series  
system unit and each FRU.  
Troubleshooting Procedures explains how to diagnose and resolve  
FRU problems.  
Test and Diagnostics describes how to perform test and diagnostic  
operations for maintenance service.  
Replacement Procedures describes the removal and replacement of the  
FRUs.  
Appendices The appendices describe the following:  
Handling the LCD module  
Board layout  
Pin assignment  
Display codes  
Key layout  
Wiring diagrams  
BIOS/KBC/EC Update  
Reliability  
iv  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Conventions  
This manual uses the following formats to describe, identify, and highlight terms and  
operating procedures.  
Acronyms  
On the first appearance and whenever necessary for clarification acronyms are enclosed in  
parentheses following their definition. For example:  
Read Only Memory (ROM)  
Keys  
Keys are used in the text to describe many operations. The key top symbol as it appears on  
the keyboard is printed in boldface type.  
Key operation  
Some operations require you to simultaneously use two or more keys. We identify such  
operations by the key top symbols separated by a plus (+) sign. For example, Ctrl + Pause  
(Break) means you must hold down Ctrl and at the same time press Pause (Break). If  
three keys are used, hold down the first two and at the same time press the third.  
User input  
Text that you are instructed to type in is shown in the boldface type below:  
DISKCOPY A: B:  
The display  
Text generated by this computer that appears on its display is presented in the type face  
below:  
Format complete  
System transferred  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
Chapter 1  
Hardware Overview  
1.1  
1.2  
1.3  
1.4  
1.5  
1.6  
1.7  
1.8  
1.9  
Features...................................................................................................................... 1-1  
System Block Diagram .............................................................................................. 1-6  
3.5-inch USB Floppy Disk Drive............................................................................. 1-10  
2.5-inch Hard Disk Drive......................................................................................... 1-11  
CD-ROM Drive ....................................................................................................... 1-13  
DVD-ROM Drive .................................................................................................... 1-15  
DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive .............................................................................. 1-18  
DVD Super Multi Drive........................................................................................... 1-21  
Keyboard.................................................................................................................. 1-24  
1.10 TFT Color Display................................................................................................... 1-25  
1.11 Power Supply........................................................................................................... 1-28  
1.12 Batteries ................................................................................................................... 1-30  
1.13 AC Adapter .............................................................................................................. 1-33  
Chapter 2  
Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.1  
2.2  
2.3  
2.4  
2.5  
2.6  
2.7  
2.8  
2.9  
Troubleshooting......................................................................................................... 2-1  
Troubleshooting Flowchart........................................................................................ 2-2  
Power Supply Troubleshooting.................................................................................. 2-6  
System Board Troubleshooting................................................................................ 2-15  
3.5” FDD Troubleshooting ...................................................................................... 2-29  
2.5” HDD Troubleshooting...................................................................................... 2-32  
Keyboard Troubleshooting ...................................................................................... 2-37  
Display Troubleshooting.......................................................................................... 2-38  
Touch Pad Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 2-41  
2.10 Optical Drive Troubleshooting ................................................................................ 2-42  
2.11 Modem Troubleshooting.......................................................................................... 2-43  
2.12 LAN Troubleshooting.............................................................................................. 2-44  
vi  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.13 Sound Troubleshooting............................................................................................ 2-45  
2.14 Wireless LAN Troubleshooting............................................................................... 2-47  
Chapter 3  
Tests and Diagnostics  
3.1  
3.2  
3.3  
3.4  
3.5  
3.6  
3.7  
3.8  
3.9  
The Diagnostic Test................................................................................................... 3-1  
Executing the Diagnostic Test ................................................................................... 3-4  
Setting of the hardware configuration........................................................................ 3-8  
Heatrun Test............................................................................................................. 3-11  
Subtest Names.......................................................................................................... 3-12  
System Test.............................................................................................................. 3-14  
Memory Test............................................................................................................ 3-16  
Keyboard Test.......................................................................................................... 3-17  
Display Test ............................................................................................................. 3-18  
3.10 Floppy Disk Test...................................................................................................... 3-21  
3.11 Printer Test............................................................................................................... 3-23  
3.12 Async Test ............................................................................................................... 3-25  
3.13 Hard Disk Test......................................................................................................... 3-26  
3.14 Real Timer Test........................................................................................................ 3-29  
3.15 NDP Test.................................................................................................................. 3-31  
3.16 Expansion Test......................................................................................................... 3-32  
3.17 CD-ROM/DVD-ROM Test ..................................................................................... 3-34  
3.18 Error Code and Error Status Names......................................................................... 3-35  
3.19 Hard Disk Test Detail Status.................................................................................... 3-38  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST................................................................................................... 3-40  
3.21 Head Cleaning.......................................................................................................... 3-46  
3.22 Log Utilities ............................................................................................................. 3-47  
3.23 Running Test............................................................................................................ 3-49  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities...................................................................................... 3-50  
3.25 System Configuration .............................................................................................. 3-55  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)......................................................... 3-57  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)...................................................... 3-61  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)............................................................ 3-66  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program .................................................. 3-70  
3.30 Sound Test program................................................................................................. 3-84  
3.31 SETUP ..................................................................................................................... 3-90  
Chapter 4  
Replacement Procedures  
4.1  
4.2  
4.3  
4.4  
4.5  
4.6  
4.7  
4.8  
4.9  
Overview.................................................................................................................... 4-1  
Battery Pack/PC Card ................................................................................................ 4-8  
Memory Module ...................................................................................................... 4-11  
MDC ........................................................................................................................ 4-14  
HDD......................................................................................................................... 4-16  
Wireless LAN Card.................................................................................................. 4-19  
Cooling Fin/CPU ..................................................................................................... 4-21  
Keyboard.................................................................................................................. 4-26  
Switch Membrane Board ......................................................................................... 4-30  
4.10 Optical Drive............................................................................................................ 4-32  
4.11 Display Assembly .................................................................................................... 4-34  
4.12 Sound Board............................................................................................................. 4-38  
4.13 Parallel port board/Serial port board/S-Video board ............................................... 4-39  
4.14 FAN.......................................................................................................................... 4-46  
4.15 System Board/DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery................................................................. 4-47  
4.16 PC card cover........................................................................................................... 4-50  
4.17 Battery Latch............................................................................................................ 4-51  
4.18 Battery Lock............................................................................................................. 4-53  
4.19 Touch Pad ............................................................................................................... 4-55  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter.............................................................................................. 4-57  
4.21 Latch Assembly ....................................................................................................... 4-61  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge................................................................... 4-62  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp..................................................................................................... 4-71  
Appendices  
Appendix A  
Appendix B  
Handling the LCD Module ........................................................................ A-1  
Board Layout ............................................................................................. B-1  
viii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-  
534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C  
Appendix D  
Appendix E  
Appendix F  
Appendix G  
Appendix H  
Pin Assignment .......................................................................................... C-1  
Keyboard Scan/Character Codes ............................................................... D-1  
Key Layout..................................................................................................E-1  
Wiring Diagrams.........................................................................................F-1  
BIOS/KBC/EC Update .............................................................................. G-1  
Reliability................................................................................................... H-1  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
x
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 1  
Hardware Overview  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1
Hardware Overview  
1-ii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
Chapter 1  
Contents  
1.1  
1.2  
1.3  
1.4  
1.5  
1.6  
1.7  
1.8  
1.9  
Features...................................................................................................................... 1-1  
System Block Diagram .............................................................................................. 1-6  
3.5-inch USB Floppy Disk Drive............................................................................. 1-10  
2.5-inch Hard Disk Drive......................................................................................... 1-11  
CD-ROM Drive ....................................................................................................... 1-13  
DVD-ROM Drive .................................................................................................... 1-15  
DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive.............................................................................. 1-18  
DVD Super Multi Drive........................................................................................... 1-21  
Keyboard.................................................................................................................. 1-24  
1.10 TFT Color Display................................................................................................... 1-25  
1.10.1  
1.10.2  
LCD Module ....................................................................................... 1-25  
FL Inverter Board................................................................................ 1-27  
1.11 Power Supply........................................................................................................... 1-28  
1.12 Batteries ................................................................................................................... 1-30  
1.12.1  
1.12.2  
1.12.3  
Main Battery........................................................................................ 1-30  
Battery Charging Control.................................................................... 1-31  
RTC Battery ........................................................................................ 1-32  
1.13 AC Adapter.............................................................................................................. 1-33  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
Figures  
Figure 1-1  
Figure 1-2  
Figure 1-3  
Figure 1-4  
Figure 1-5  
Figure 1-6  
Figure 1-7  
Figure 1-8  
Figure 1-9  
Front of the computer..................................................................................... 1-4  
System units configuration ............................................................................ 1-5  
System block diagram.................................................................................... 1-6  
3.5-inch USB FDD....................................................................................... 1-10  
2.5-inch HDD............................................................................................... 1-11  
CD-ROM Drive ........................................................................................... 1-13  
DVD-ROM Drive ........................................................................................ 1-15  
DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive.................................................................. 1-18  
DVD Super Multi Drive............................................................................... 1-21  
Figure 1-10 Keyboard...................................................................................................... 1-24  
Figure 1-11 LCD module................................................................................................. 1-25  
Tables  
Table 1-1  
Table 1-2  
Table 1-3  
Table 1-4  
Table 1-5  
Table 1-6  
Table 1-7  
Table 1-8  
Table 1-9  
Table 1-10  
Table 1-11  
Table 1-12  
Table 1-13  
Table 1-14  
Table 1-15  
Table 1-16  
Table 1-17  
3.5-inch USB FDD specifications................................................................ 1-10  
2.5-inch HDD dimensions ........................................................................... 1-11  
2.5-inch HDD specifications........................................................................ 1-12  
CD-ROM Drive dimensions ........................................................................ 1-13  
CD-ROM Drive specifications .................................................................... 1-14  
DVD-ROM Drive dimensions..................................................................... 1-15  
DVD-ROM Drive specifications ................................................................. 1-16  
DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive dimensions............................................... 1-18  
DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive specifications........................................... 1-19  
DVD Super Multi Drive dimensions ........................................................... 1-21  
DVD Super Multi Drive speciifcations........................................................ 1-22  
LCD module specifications.......................................................................... 1-26  
FL inverter board specifications .................................................................. 1-27  
Power supply output rating.......................................................................... 1-29  
Battery specifications................................................................................... 1-30  
Time required for charges of main battery .................................................. 1-31  
Battery preservation time............................................................................. 1-31  
1-iv  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
Table 1-18  
Table 1-19  
Time required for charges of RTC battery................................................... 1-32  
AC adapter specifications ............................................................................ 1-33  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-v  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1-vi  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.1 Features  
1 Hardware Overview  
1
Features  
1.1 Features  
The Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X is a high performance all-in-one PC running a Pentium M  
or Celeron M processor.  
Features are listed below.  
Microprocessor [CPU Easy Replaceable]  
Microprocessor used is different from each model.  
Mobile Intel® Pentium® -M model  
A 730/740/750/760/770/780 Pentium M processor with 533MHz bus operation.  
Mobile Intel® Celeron ® -M model  
A 360/370/380/390 Celeron M processor with 400MHz bus operation.  
Memory  
Two SO-DIMM slots for DDR2-533. Memory modules can be installed to provide a  
maximum of 2GB. Memory modules are available in 256MB, 512MB and 1,024MB  
sizes. (Celeron M processor model operates with DDR2-400)  
Montara-GML model can support 1GB in total as its maximum memory.  
Montara-GM+ model can support 2GB in total as its maximum memory.  
HDD  
Single 20GB, 30GB, 40GB, 60GB or 80GB internal drive. 2.5 inch x 9.5mm height.  
USB FDD  
The two-mode 3.5-inch USB FDD supports 720KB, and 1.44MB formats.  
Display  
LCD  
Built-in 15.0-inch, XGA (1,024 x 768 dots), or 15-inch, SXGA+ (1,400 x 1,050  
dots), 262,144 colors, amorphous silicon TFT color display.  
Interface  
Image output  
- an RGB connector  
- an S-Video connector (It depends on the model.)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.1 Features  
VRAM  
The computer has VGA imbedded in North Bridge and VRAM in 128MB(max).  
Keyboard  
An easy-to-use 85(US)-/86(UK)-key keyboard. Windows key is supported.  
The keyboard also supports touchpad as a pointing device.  
Optical devices  
A CD-ROM, DVD-ROM, DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW or DVD Super Multi (supporting  
Double Layer) Drive is supported.  
Battery  
The RTC battery is mounted inside the computer.  
The main battery is a detachable lithium ion battery (4,400mAh: Li-Ion, 6cell /  
8,800mAh: Li-Ion, 12cell).  
USB (Universal Serial Bus)  
Two or three USB ports are provided. The ports comply with the USB2.0 standard,  
which enables data transfer speeds 40 times faster than USB1.1 standard. USB1.1 is  
also supported.  
PC card slot  
The PC card slot accepts one Type II (5mm thick) card. The slot is equipped with an  
ejector and supports ToPIC-100 (3.3V/CardBus).  
Parallel port (It depends on the model.)  
A parallel port is provided for some models.  
Serial port (It depends on the model.)  
A serial port is provided for some models.  
Sound system  
The computer has an external monaural microphone connector, stereo headphone  
connector and internal stereo speakers.  
Wireless LAN (Mini PCI slot)  
The wireless LAN card (802.11b/g or 802.11a/b/g) is equipped on the mini PCI slot.  
1-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.1 Features  
1 Hardware Overview  
LAN/MODEM  
Connectors for LAN and Modem are separately mounted.  
RGB  
The port enables connection of an external monitor.  
Docking interface port  
Advanced Port Replicator III can be connected through docking port on the bottom.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.1 Features  
Figure 1-1 shows the front of the computer.  
Figure 1-1 Front of the computer  
1-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.1 Features  
1 Hardware Overview  
Figure 1-2 shows the system units configuration.  
Figure 1-2 System units configuration  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.2 System Block Diagram  
1.2 System Block Diagram  
Figure 1-3 shows the system block diagram.  
Figure 1-3 System Block Diagram  
1-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.2 System Block Diagram  
1 Hardware Overview  
The PC contains the following components.  
CPU  
Intel® Mobile Pentium® -M model  
Pentium-M 1.60GHz (Processor Number ; 730)  
1.73GHz (Processor Number ; 740)  
1.86GHz (Processor Number ; 750)  
2.00GHz (Processor Number ; 760)  
2.13GHz (Processor Number ; 770)  
2.26GHz (Processor Number ; 780)  
L1 cache : 64KB (32KB + 32KB)  
L2 cache : 2MB  
FSB : 533MHz  
Core voltage : 1.280~1.356V  
Intel® Mobile Celeron® -M model  
Celeron-M 1.40GHz (Processor Number ; 360)  
1.50GHz (Processor Number ; 370)  
1.60GHz (Processor Number ; 380)  
1.70GHz (Processor Number ; 390)  
L1 cache : 64KB (32KB + 32KB)  
L2 cache : 1MB  
FSB : 400MHz  
Core voltage : 1.004~1.292V  
Memory  
Two memory slots capable of accepting 256MB, 512MB or 1024MB memory  
modules for a maximum of 2GB.  
200-pin DDR-SDRAM (PC4300)  
Pipeline configuration  
2.5V operation  
Firmware Hub  
8Mbit (Flash memory)  
Vcc : 3.3V±0.3V  
Vpp : 3.3V/12V  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.2 System Block Diagram  
Chipset  
This gate array has the following elements and functions.  
¾ North Bridge (Intel 915GM <Express Chipset>)  
- Support Pentium-M(915GM)/Celeron-M(915GM/910GML) Processor  
System Bus  
- System Memory Interface  
- Memory Controller : DDR333/DDR2-400/DDR2-533, 2GB(max)  
- Graphics I/F : x16 PCI Express Based Graphics I/F  
- DMI (Direct Media Interface)  
- Integrated Display interface  
- 1,257-ball 40.0mmx37.5mmx2.6mm FC-BGA Package  
¾ South Bridge (Intel 82801DBM (ICH6-M))  
- DMI (Direct Media Interface)  
- PCI Express I/F (4 ports)  
- PCI Bus I/F Rev 2.3 (PCI REQ/GNT Pairs)  
- Integrated Serial ATA Host Controller (2 ports, 150MB/S)  
- Integrated IDE Controller (Ultra ATA 100/66/33)  
- AC’97 2.3 codes  
- USB 1.1/2.0 Controller 8 ports (EHCI: Enhanced Host Controller  
Interface)  
- Built-in LAN Controller (Wfm 2.0& IEEE802.3 compliance)  
- Power Management (ACPI 2.0 compliance)  
- SMBus2.0 controller  
- FWH interface (BIOS)  
- LPC interface (EC/KBC, Super I/O)  
- IRQ controller  
- Serial Interrupt Function  
- Suspend/Resume control  
- Built-in RTC  
- GPIO  
- 609-ball 31mmx31mm micro BGA Package  
PC card controller (Texas Instruments PCI7411)  
- PCI Interface (PCI Rev. 2.3)  
- PC Card Controller  
- IEEE1394 Controller  
- Flash Media Controller  
- SD Host Controller  
1-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.2 System Block Diagram  
1 Hardware Overview  
VGA controller  
Imbedded in North Bridge  
Other main system chips  
EC/KBC (M306KAFCLRP x 1)  
PSC (Toshiba-made TMP86PM49UG x 1)  
Thermal sensor (AnalogDevice-made ADM1032 x 1)  
Audio AMP (Mitsumi-made MM1517X x1)  
AC97-CODEC (SigmaTel-made STAC9750TG x1)  
Clock generator (ICS954204 x1)  
Mini PCI (Intel/Askey made 802.11b/g or 802.11a/b/g)  
2.4 GHz DSSS wireless LAN card is equipped in the mini PCI card slot. Conformity  
with IEEE 802.11b (WiFi). Supports 128bit WEP.  
LAN (Intel-made Kinnereth (ED82562 x 1)  
Controls LAN.  
Supports 100Base-TX and 10Base-T.  
MODEM (Askey-made 1456VQL4A (INT) x 1)  
Supported by MDC.  
Uses secondary AC97 line.  
Data and FAX transmission is available.  
Supports ITU-TV.90 and V.92.  
The transfer speed of data receiving is 56kbps, of data sending is 33.6kbps and of  
FAX is 14.4Kbps. Actual speed depends on the quality of the line used.  
Connected to telephone line through RJ11 modem jack.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.3 3.5-inch USB Floppy Disk Drive  
1.3 3.5-inch USB Floppy Disk Drive  
This compact, lightweight and high-reliability FDD can be used with 720KB and 1.44MB  
floppy disks.  
Figure 1-4 shows the 3.5-inch FDD. Table 1-1 lists the specifications.  
Figure 1-4 3.5-inch USB FDD  
Table 1-1 3.5-inch USB FDD specifications  
Item  
Specifications  
Disk used  
2DD  
2HD  
Unformatted capacity  
Formatted capacity  
1.0MB  
720KB  
2.0MB  
1.44MB  
Data transfer speed  
Kb/s)  
250  
300  
500  
300  
Rotation speedrpm)  
1-10  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.4 2.5-inch Hard Disk Drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.4 2.5-inch Hard Disk Drive  
The computer has a compact, high-capacity HDD with a height of 9.5 mm. The HDD  
contains a 2.5-inch magnetic disk and magnetic heads.  
Figure 1-5 shows a view of the 2.5-inch HDD and Tables 1-2 and 1-3 list the dimensions and  
specifications.  
Figure 1-5 2.5-inch HDD  
Table 1-2 2.5-inch HDD dimensions (1/2)  
Standard  
Item  
TOSHIBA  
HDD2193VZK01  
HDD2194VZK01  
HDD2191VZK01  
Width (mm)  
Height (mm)  
69.85  
9.5  
Depth (mm)  
100.0  
95  
Weight (g) (MAX)  
Table 1-2 2.5-inch HDD dimensions (2/2)  
Standard  
Item  
HITACHI-GST  
G8BC0001N410 G8BC0001N610 G8BC0001N810 G8BC0001NA10  
Width (mm)  
Height (mm)  
69.85±0.25  
9.5±0.2  
Depth (mm)  
100.2±0.25  
Weight (g) (MAX)  
95  
102  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.4 2.5-inch Hard Disk Drive  
Table 1-3 2.5-inch HDD specifications (1/2)  
Specifications  
TOSHIBA  
Item  
HDD2193VZK01  
HDD2194VZK01  
60GB  
HDD2191VZK01  
Storage size (formatted)  
Rotation speed (RPM)  
Data transfer rate (MB/s)  
40GB  
80GB  
5,400  
154.3-298.0  
728  
258.0-394.0  
233.0-446.0  
728  
Interface transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
100  
Storage density (Kbpi)  
Track density (Ktpi)  
735  
88.8  
Average random seek time  
(read) (ms)  
12  
Average random seek time  
(write) (ms)  
12  
4
Motor startup time (ms)  
Table 1-3 2.5-inch HDD specifications (2/2)  
Specifications  
Item  
HITACHI-GST  
G8BC0001N410  
G8BC0001N610  
G8BC0001N810 G8BC0001NA10  
Storage size (formatted)  
Rotation speed (RPM)  
Data transfer rate (MB/s)  
40GB  
60GB  
80GB  
100GB  
5,400  
493  
Interface transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
100  
Storage density (Kbpi)  
Track density (Ktpi)  
717  
764  
96.6  
113.2  
Average random seek time  
(read) (ms)  
14  
Average random seek time  
(write) (ms)  
12  
Motor startup time (ms)  
3.5  
1-12  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.5 CD-ROM Drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.5 CD-ROM Drive  
The CD-ROM drive accommodates either 12 cm (4.72-inch) or 8 cm (3.15-inch) CD. It is a  
high-performance drive that reads at maximum 24-speed.  
The CD-ROM drive is shown in Figure 1-6. The specifications of the CD-ROM drive are  
described in Table 1-4 and 1-5.  
Figure 1-6 CD-ROM drive  
Table 1-4 CD-ROM drive dimensions  
Standard  
Item  
Maker  
TEAC  
(G8CC0002R220)  
Width (mm)  
Height (mm)  
Depth (mm)  
Weight (g)  
Dimensions  
128  
12.7  
129.4  
165 (max)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.5 CD-ROM Drive  
Table 1-5 CD-ROM drive specifications  
Specifications  
Items  
TEAC  
(G8CC0002R220)  
Data transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
33.3Mbytes/sec (max)  
1,545 – 3,600KB/sec  
Transfer  
Speed  
Burst data  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
PIO mode 16.7 MB/s (PIO MODE4)  
DMA mode 16.7 MB/s (Multiword MODE2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA MODE2)  
110 (Random)  
240 (Full stroke)  
256KB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
CD-ROM  
Buffer memory  
CD-DA, CD-ROM Mode1, Mode2  
CD-ROM XA Mode2 (Form1, Form2),  
Photo CD (single/multi-session), Enhanced CD  
Supported  
formats  
CD  
1-14  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.6 DVD-ROM Drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.6 DVD-ROM Drive  
The DVD-ROM drive accommodates either 12 cm (4.72-inch) or 8 cm (3.15-inch) CD, CD-  
R/RW and DVD. It is a high-performance drive that reads DVD at maximum 8-speed, and  
reads CD at maximum 24-speed (3,600 KB per second).  
The DVD-ROM drive is shown in Figure 1-7. The specifications of the DVD-ROM drive are  
described in Table 1-6 and 1-7.  
Figure 1-7 DVD-ROM drive  
Table 1-6 DVD-ROM drive dimensions  
Standard  
Item  
Maker  
TSST  
(G8CC0002W220)  
TEAC  
(G8CC0002E220)  
Width (mm)  
Height (mm)  
Depth (mm)  
Weight (g)  
Dimensions  
128  
12.7  
129.0  
179 ±15  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.6 DVD-ROM Drive  
Table 1-7 DVD-ROM drive specifications (1/2)  
Specifications  
TSST  
Items  
(G8CC0002W220)  
DVD(Single Layer); 4,460-10,816 (CAV)  
DVD(Dual Layer); 3,380-8,112 (CAV)  
DVD-R/-RW2,298-5,408 (CAV)  
DVD+R/+RW2,298-5,408 (CAV)  
DVD+R Double Layer; 2,298-5,408 (CAV)  
DVD-RAM; 2,704 (ZoneCLV)  
Data transfer  
rate  
(MB/s)  
Transfer Speed  
CD(Mode1); 1,546-3,600 (CAV)  
CD(Mode2); 1,761-4,104 (CAV)  
Burst data  
PIO mode 16.7 MB/s (PIO Mode 4)  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
DMA mode 16.7 MB/s (Multi-word DMA Mode 2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA Mode 2)  
CD-ROM  
DVD-ROM  
DVD-RAM  
110 (Random)  
110 (Random)  
140 (Random)  
256KB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
Buffer Memory  
CD-DA, CD+(E)G, CD-MIDI,CD-text, CD-ROM,  
CD-ROM XA, CD-I, CD-I Bridge, Multi-session CD, CD-R,  
CD-RW  
CD  
Supported  
formats  
DVD-ROM (DVD-5, DVD-9, DVD-10, DVD-18), DVD-R  
(Ver1.0, 2.1), DVD-RW (Ver1.0, 1.1)  
DVD+R, DVD+R DL, DVD+RW,  
DVD  
DVD-RAM (Ver2.1)  
1-16  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.6 DVD-ROM Drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
Table 1-7 DVD-ROM drive specifications (2/2)  
Specifications  
TEAC  
Items  
(G8CC0002E220)  
DVD-ROM; 8x (CAV)  
DVD-Video; 4x (CAV)  
CD-ROM (Mode1); 24x (CAV)  
CD-ROM (Mode2); 20x (CAV)  
CD-DA; 20x (CAV)  
Data transfer  
rate  
(MB/s)  
CD-RW; 24x (CAV)  
DVD-R/-RW; 8x (CAV)  
Transfer Speed  
DVD+R/+RW; 8x (CAV)  
DVD-RAM (4.7GB); 5x (CAV)  
DVD-RAM (2.6GB); 2.5x (CAV)  
Burst data  
PIO mode 16.7 MB/s (PIO Mode 4)  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
DMA mode 16.7 MB/s (Multi-word DMA Mode 2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA Mode 2)  
CD-ROM  
120 (Random)  
130 (Random)  
256KB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
DVD-ROM  
Buffer Memory  
CD-DA, CD-ROM Mode1, CD-ROM XA Mode2,  
Multi-session CD, CD-I, Video CD, Enhanced CD,  
CD-TEXT, Photo CD, Addressing Method2  
CD  
Supported  
formats  
DVD-ROM, DVD-R, DVD Video, DVD-RW  
DVD+R, DVD+RW, DVD-RAM (2.6GB/4.7GB)  
DVD  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.7 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive  
1.7 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive  
The DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW drive accommodates either 12 cm (4.72-inch) or 8 cm (3.15-  
inch) CD, CD-R/RW and DVD. It is a high-performance drive that reads DVD at maximum  
8-speed, and reads CD at maximum 24-speed.  
The DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW drive is shown in Figure 1-8. The specifications of the DVD-  
ROM & CD-R/RW drive are described in Table 1-8 and 1-9.  
Figure 1-8 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW drive  
Table 1-8 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW drive dimensions  
Items  
Maker  
Standard  
Panasonic  
TSST  
(G8CC0002J220)  
(G8CC0002V220)  
Width (mm)  
Height (mm)  
Depth (mm)  
Weight (g)  
Dimensions  
128  
12.7  
129.0  
180 ±10  
179 ±15  
1-18  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.7 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
Table 1-9 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW drive specifications (1/2)  
Specifications  
Items  
Panasonic  
(G8CC0002J220)  
CD-ROM; 24x (CAV)  
DVD-ROM MAX 8x CAV  
Read(KB/s)  
Write  
CD-R 24x (CAV)  
CD-RW 4x (CLV)  
High Speed CD-RW 10x (CLV)  
Ultra Speed CD-RW 24x (CAV)  
Transfer Speed  
Burst data  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
PIO mode 16.6 MB/s (PIO Mode 4)  
DMA mode 16.6 MB/s (Multi-word DMA Mode 2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA Mode 2)  
CD-ROM  
150 (Random)  
180 (Random)  
2MB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
DVD-ROM  
Buffer Memory  
CD-DA, CD-ROM, CD-ROM XA, Photo CD,  
CD-Extra(CD+), CD-Text  
CD  
Supported  
formats  
DVD-R, DVD-RW,  
DVD Video, DVD+R, DVD+RW,  
DVD-RAM  
DVD  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.7 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW Drive  
Table 1-9 DVD-ROM & CD-R/RW drive specifications (2/2)  
Specifications  
Items  
TSST  
(G8CC0002V220)  
CD-ROM; 24x (CAV)  
CD-RW; 24x (CAV)  
DVD-ROM MAX 8x CAV  
Read(KB/s)  
Write  
CD-R 24x (P-CAV)  
CD-RW 4x (CLV)  
High Speed CD-RW 10x (CLV)  
Ultra Speed CD-RW 24x (P-CAV)  
Transfer Speed  
Burst data  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
PIO mode 16.6 MB/s (PIO Mode 4)  
DMA mode 16.6 MB/s (Multi-word DMA Mode 2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA Mode 2)  
CD-ROM  
130 (Random)  
150 (Random)  
2MB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
DVD-ROM  
Buffer Memory  
CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, CD-Audio Disc,  
CD-DA, Video-CD  
CD  
Supported  
formats  
DVD-R, DVD-RW,  
DVD Video, DVD+R, DVD+RW,  
DVD-RAM  
DVD  
1-20  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.8 DVD Super Multi drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.8 DVD Super Multi drive  
The DVD Multi drive accommodates either 12 cm (4.72-inch) or 8 cm (3.15-inch) CD, CD-  
R/RW and DVD. It is a high-performance drive that reads CD at maximum 24-speed (3,600  
KB per second) and writes DVD-RW at 2-speed, DVD-RAM at 2-speed, DVD-R at4-speed,  
DVD+R at 2.4-speed and DVD+RW at 2.4-speed.  
The DVD Super Multi drive is shown in Figure 1-9. The specifications of the DVD Super  
Multi drive are described in Table 1-10 and 1-11.  
Figure 1-9 DVD Super Multi drive  
Table 1-10 DVD Super Multi drive dimensions  
Items  
Maker  
Standards  
Panasonic  
TEAC  
(G8CC0002T220)  
(G8CC0002S220)  
Width (mm)  
Height (mm)  
Depth (mm)  
Weight (g)  
Dimensions  
128  
12.7  
129.0  
129.4  
190 (max)  
190 ±10  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.8 DVD Super Multi drive  
Table 1-11 DVD Super Multi drive specifications (1/2)  
Specifications  
Items  
Panasonic  
(G8CC0002T220)  
DVD-ROM MAX 8x CAV  
CD-ROM MAX 24x CAV  
Read(KB/s)  
CD-R 24x (ZoneCLV)  
CD-RW 4x (CLV)  
High Speed CD-RW 10x (CLV)  
Ultra Speed CD-RW 10x (CLV)  
DVD-R 8x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD-R Double Layer 2x (CLV)  
DVD-RW 4x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD+R 8x (ZoneCLV)  
Transfer Speed  
Write  
DVD+R Double Layer 2.4x (CLV)  
DVD+RW 4x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD-RAM 5x (ZoneCLV)  
Burst data  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
PIO mode 16.6 MB/s (PIO Mode 4)  
DMA mode 16.6 MB/s (Multi-word DMA Mode 2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA Mode 2)  
CD-ROM  
150 (Random)  
180 (Random)  
2MB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
DVD-ROM  
Buffer memory  
CD-DA, CD-ROM, CD-ROM XA,  
Photo CD, CD-Extra(CD+),CD-text  
CD  
Supported  
formats  
DVD-R, DVD-RW (Ver1.1)  
DVD Video, DVD+R, DVD+RW,  
DVD-RAM (2.6GB/4.7GB)  
DVD  
1-22  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.8 DVD Super Multi drive  
1 Hardware Overview  
Table 1-11 DVD Super Multi drive specifications (2/2)  
Specifications  
Items  
TEAC  
(G8CC0002S220)  
DVD-ROM 8x (CAV)  
CD-ROM 24x (CAV)  
Read(KB/s)  
Write  
CD-R 24x (ZoneCLV)  
CD-RW 16x (CLV)  
DVD-R 8x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD-RW 4x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD+R 8x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD+R Double Layer 2.4x (CLV)  
DVD+RW 4x (ZoneCLV)  
DVD-RAM 3x (ZoneCLV)  
Transfer Speed  
Burst data  
transfer rate  
(MB/s)  
PIO mode 16.7 MB/s (PIO Mode 4)  
DMA mode 16.7 MB/s (Multi-word DMA Mode 2)  
Ultra DMA mode 33.3 MB/s (Ultra DMA Mode 2)  
CD-ROM  
130 (Random)  
130 (Random)  
2MB  
Access Time  
(ms)  
DVD-ROM  
Buffer memory  
CD-DA, CD-ROM, CD-ROM XA, CD-I, Video CD,  
Photo CD, CD-Extra(CD+),CD-text  
CD  
Supported  
formats  
DVD-R, DVD-RW (Ver1.1), DVD Video, DVD+R,  
DVD+R (Double layer), DVD+RW,  
DVD-RAM (2.6GB/4.7GB)  
DVD  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.9 Keyboard  
1.9 Keyboard  
An 85(US)-/86(UK)- key keyboard is mounted on the system unit. The keyboard is  
connected to membrane connector on the system board and controlled by the keyboard  
controller.  
Figure 1-10 shows a view of the keyboard.  
See Appendix E for details of the keyboard layout.  
Figure 1-10 Keyboard  
1-24  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.10 TFT Color Display  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.10 TFT Color Display  
The TFT color display has a 15.0-inch (XGA, SXGA+) LCD module and the FL inverter  
board.  
1.10.1 LCD Module  
The LCD module used for the TFT color display uses a backlight as the light source and can  
display a maximum of 262,144 colors with 1,024 x 768 or 1,400 x 1,050 resolution. North  
Bridge can control both internal and external XGA or SXGA+ support displays  
simultaneously.  
Figure 1-11 shows a view of the LCD module and Table 1-12 lists the specifications.  
Figure 1-11 LCD module  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.10 TFT Color Display  
Table 1-12 LCD module specifications (15.0-inch XGA TFT) (1/2)  
Specifications  
G33C0002Y110  
Item  
G33C0002W110  
G33C00030110  
Number of Dots  
1,024(W) ×768(H)  
0.297(H)×0.297(V)  
304.128(H)×228.096(V)  
Dot spacing (mm)  
Display range (mm)  
Table 1-12 LCD module specifications (15.0-inch SXGA+ TFT) (2/2)  
Specifications  
Item  
G33C0001X210  
Number of Dots  
1,400(W)×1,050(H)  
0.2175(H)×0.2175(V)  
304.5(H)×228.375(V)  
Dot spacing (mm)  
Display range (mm)  
1-26  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.10 TFT Color Display  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.10.2 FL Inverter Board  
The FL inverter board supplies a high frequency current to illuminate the LCD module  
fluorescent lamp.  
Table 1-13 lists the FL inverter board specifications.  
Table 1-13 FL inverter board specifications  
Item  
Voltage (V)  
Specifications  
DC5  
7
Input  
Power (W)  
Voltage (V)  
Current (mA)  
Power (W)  
750  
Output  
6.00  
5W/7VA  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.11 Power Supply  
1.11 Power Supply  
The power supply supplies 26 different voltages to the system board.  
The power supply microcontroller has the following functions.  
1. Judges if the DC power supply (AC adapter) is connected to the computer.  
2. Detects DC output and circuit malfunctions.  
3. Controls the battery icon, and DC IN icon.  
4. Turns the battery charging system on and off and detects a fully charged battery.  
5. Turns the power supply on and off.  
6. Provides more accurate detection of a low battery.  
7. Calculates the remaining battery capacity.  
8. Controls the transmission of the status signal of the main battery.  
Table 1-14 lists the power supply output specifications.  
1-28  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.11 Power Supply  
1 Hardware Overview  
Table 1-14 Power supply output rating  
Power Supply (Yes / No)  
Voltage  
[V]  
Name  
PPV  
S3  
S4/S5  
G3  
Use  
1.308 –  
0.748  
1.05  
No  
No  
No  
CPU  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
PTV  
PGV  
CPU, MCH, ICH6-M  
GPU  
1.056  
CPU, MCH, ICH6-M,  
ExpressCard  
No  
No  
No  
1R5-P1V  
1.5  
Yes  
No  
No  
1R8-B1V  
1.8  
MCH, DDR2-SDRAM  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
VG1R8-P1V  
2R5-P2V  
MR0R9-B0V  
0R9-P0V  
1.8  
2.5  
0.9  
0.9  
GPU  
MCH, ICH6-M  
MCH, DDR2-SDRAM  
DDR2-SDRAM  
Clock Generator, GPU,  
Thermal Sensor, TPM,  
SDRAM(SPD), Mini-PCI,  
Super I/O, ICH6-M,  
LCD, Express Card,  
FWH, FIR, STAC9200,  
HDD(SATA),  
No  
No  
No  
P3V  
3.3  
Finger Print Sensor  
ICH6-M, TI CARD Cont., PC  
Card Power, Mini-PCI, Express  
Card, MDC, RS-232C  
SD Card  
LAN Power  
LAN Power  
Bluetooth  
USB  
Yes  
No  
E3V  
3.3  
Yes / No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
SD-E3V  
LAN-E3V  
LAN2R5-E2V  
BT-P3V  
USB0PS-E5V  
USB1PS-E5V  
3.3  
3.3  
2.5  
3.3  
5
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
No  
Yes / No  
Yes / No  
5
USB  
EC/KBC, PSC,  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
S3V  
3.3  
3AXIS Accerelometer  
CRT, ICH6-M, FL inverter, LEDs,  
ODD, KB, PAD,Bluetooth Power,  
HDD(SATA), Parallel  
ICH6-M  
No  
No  
No  
P5V  
5
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
1R5-E1V  
SND-P5V  
A4R7-P4V  
1.5  
5
4.7  
Yes / No  
No  
AN12941  
No  
STAC9200, AN12941  
ICH6-M, PC Card Power, USB  
Power  
Yes  
No  
E5V  
5
Yes / No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
M5V  
MCV  
5
5
Docker, MAX6501, LED  
PSC  
2.0 -  
3.5  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
R3V  
ICH6-M(RTC)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.12 Batteries  
1.12 Batteries  
The PC has the following two batteries.  
Main battery  
Real time clock (RTC) battery  
Table 1-15 lists the specifications for these two batteries.  
Table 1-15 Battery specifications  
Material  
Output  
Voltage  
Battery Name  
G71C0003V910  
Capacity  
G71C0003VA10  
G71C0003VD10  
G71C0003VE10  
G71C0005H110  
G71C0005H210  
G71C0004G510  
G71C0004G610  
G71C0003W210  
G71C0003W110  
4,400mAh  
lithium ion  
(6-cell)  
Main battery  
10.8V  
4,700mAh  
lithium ion  
(12-cell)  
8,800mAh  
17mAh  
Real time clock  
(RTC) battery  
Nickel metal  
hydride  
GDM710000041  
3.0V  
1.12.1 Main Battery  
The main battery is the primary power supply for the computer when the AC adapter is not  
connected. In resume (instant recovery) mode, the main battery maintains the current status  
of the computer.  
1-30  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.12 Batteries  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.12.2 Battery Charging Control  
Battery charging is controlled by a power supply microprocessor. The power supply  
microprocessor controls power supply and detects a full charge when the AC adaptor and  
battery are connected to the computer.  
Battery Charge  
When the AC adapter is connected, normal charging is used while the system is  
turned on, and quick charge is used while the system is turned off or in suspend mode.  
Table 1-16 shows the time required for charges of main battery.  
Table 1-16 Time required for charges of main battery  
Condition  
Charging Time  
About 4.5 to 12.0 hours or longer  
About 7.0 to 21.0 hours or longer  
About 3.0 hours  
Normal charge  
4,400mAh  
8,800mAh  
4,400mAh  
8,800mAh  
Quick charge  
About 4.5 hours  
Charge is stopped in the following cases.  
1. The main battery is fully charged  
2. The main battery is removed  
3. Main battery or AC adapter voltage is abnormal  
4. Charging current is abnormal  
Battery preservation time  
When turning off the power in being charged fully, the preservation time is as  
follows:  
Table 1-17 Battery preservation time  
Condition  
Preservation Time  
About 85 days  
Power OFF  
4,400mAh  
8,800mAh  
or  
About 160 days  
Hibernation  
Stanby  
4,400mAh  
8,800mAh  
About 5 days  
About 8 days  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.12 Batteries  
1.12.3 RTC Battery  
The RTC battery provides the power supply to maintain the date, time, and other system  
information in memory.  
Table 1-18 lists the Time required for charges of RTC battery.  
Table 1-18 Time required for charges of RTC battery  
Condition  
Power ON (Lights Power LED)  
Power OFF (Doesn’t light Power LED)  
Time  
8 hours or longer  
Doesn’t charge  
1-32  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.13 AC Adapter  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.13 AC Adapter  
The AC adapter is used to charge the battery.  
Table 1-19 lists the AC adapter specifications.  
Table 1-19 AC adapter specifications (1/2)  
Item  
Specifications  
G71C0002SB10 G71C0004A410  
Input voltage  
100V/240V  
50Hz/60Hz  
0.5W or less  
15.0V  
Input frequency  
No load input power  
Output voltage  
Output current  
4.0A  
Table 1-19 AC adapter specifications (2/2)  
Item  
Specifications  
G71C00049310/  
G71C00049410  
G71C00043310  
100V/240V  
Input voltage  
Input frequency  
No load input power  
Output voltage  
47Hz - 63Hz  
0.7W or less  
1.0W or less  
15.0V  
5.0A  
Output current  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
1-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1 Hardware Overview  
1.13 AC Adapter  
1-34  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2  
Troubleshooting Procedures  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2
2-ii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Chapter 2  
Contents  
2.1  
2.2  
2.3  
Troubleshooting......................................................................................................... 2-1  
Troubleshooting Flowchart........................................................................................ 2-2  
Power Supply Troubleshooting.................................................................................. 2-6  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
Procedure 4  
Procedure 5  
Power Status Check ............................................................... 2-6  
Error Code Check .................................................................. 2-8  
Connection Check................................................................ 2-13  
Charging Check ................................................................... 2-13  
Replacement Check ............................................................. 2-14  
2.4  
System Board Troubleshooting................................................................................ 2-15  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
Procedure 4  
Message Check .................................................................... 2-16  
Debug Port Check................................................................ 2-18  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-28  
Replacement Check ............................................................. 2-28  
2.5  
2.6  
3.5” FDD Troubleshooting ...................................................................................... 2-29  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
FDD Head Cleaning Check ................................................. 2-29  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-30  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-31  
2.5” HDD Troubleshooting...................................................................................... 2-32  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
Procedure 4  
Procedure 5  
Partition Check..................................................................... 2-32  
Message Check .................................................................... 2-33  
Format Check....................................................................... 2-34  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-35  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-36  
2.7  
Keyboard Troubleshooting ...................................................................................... 2-37  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-37  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-37  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.8  
Display Troubleshooting.......................................................................................... 2-38  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
Procedure 4  
External Monitor Check....................................................... 2-38  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-38  
Connector and Cable Check................................................. 2-39  
Replacement Check ............................................................. 2-40  
2.9  
Touch Pad Troubleshooting..................................................................................... 2-41  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-41  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-41  
2.10 Optical Drive Troubleshooting ................................................................................ 2-42  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-42  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-42  
2.11 Modem Troubleshooting.......................................................................................... 2-43  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-43  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-43  
2.12 LAN Troubleshooting.............................................................................................. 2-44  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-44  
Connector Check and Replacement Check.......................... 2-44  
2.13 Sound Troubleshooting............................................................................................ 2-45  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check......................... 2-45  
Connector Check.................................................................. 2-45  
Replacement Check ............................................................. 2-46  
2.14 Wireless LAN Troubleshooting............................................................................... 2-47  
Procedure 1  
Procedure 2  
Procedure 3  
Transmitting-Receiving Check ............................................ 2-47  
Antennas' Connection Check............................................... 2-47  
Replacement Check ............................................................. 2-48  
2-iv  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Figures  
Figure 2-1  
Figure 2-2  
Troubleshooting flowchart............................................................................. 2-3  
A set of tool for debug port test ................................................................... 2-18  
Tables  
Table 2-1  
Table 2-2  
Table 2-3  
Table 2-4  
Table 2-5  
Battery icon.................................................................................................... 2-6  
DC IN icon..................................................................................................... 2-6  
D port status ................................................................................................ 2-19  
FDD error code and status ........................................................................... 2-30  
2.5” Hard disk drive error code and status................................................... 2-35  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-v  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2-vi  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.1 Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2
2.1 Troubleshooting  
Chapter 2 describes how to determine which Field Replaceable Unit (FRU) in the  
computer is causing the computer to malfunction. (The “FRU” means the replaceable unit  
in the field.) The FRUs covered are:  
1. Power supply  
2. System Board  
3. 3.5” USB FDD  
4. 2.5” HDD  
7. Touch pad  
8. Optical Drive  
9. Modem  
13. Wireless LAN  
10. LAN  
5. Keyboard  
11. Sound  
12. Wireless LAN  
6. Display  
The Test Program operations are described in Chapter 3. Detailed replacement procedures  
are given in Chapter 4.  
The following tools are necessary for implementing the Diagnostics procedures (also tools  
for Chapter 3 annd Chapter 4 are necesarry if it is required.):  
1. Diagnostics Disk (Test program for maintenance)  
2. Phillips screwdrivers  
NOTE: Be sure to use the PH point size “0” screwdriver complying with the ISO/DIS  
8764-1:1996.  
3. Toshiba MS-DOS system FD  
4. Tester  
There are following two types of connections in the figure of board and module connection  
in and after 2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting.  
(1) Cable connection is described in the figure as line.  
(2) Pin connection is described in the figure as arrow.  
<Example>  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.2 Troubleshooting Flowchart  
2.2 Troubleshooting Flowchart  
Use the flowchart in Figure 2-1 as a guide for determining which troubleshooting  
procedure is executed. Before going through the flowchart steps, check the following:  
Make sure that Toshiba Windows® OS is installed on the hard disk. Non-Toshiba  
operating systems can cause the computer malfunction.  
Make sure all optional equipment is removed from the computer.  
2-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.2 Troubleshooting Flowchart  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Figure 2-1 Troubleshooting flowchart (1/2)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.2 Troubleshooting Flowchart  
Figure 2-1 Troubleshooting flowchart (2/2)  
2-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.2 Troubleshooting Flowchart  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
If the diagnostics program cannot detect an error, the problem may be intermittent. The  
Test program should be executed several times to isolate the problem. Check the Log  
Utilities function to confirm which diagnostic test detected an error(s), then perform the  
appropriate troubleshooting procedures as follows:  
1. If an error is detected on the system test, memory test, printer test, Async test,  
expansion test, real timer test, NDP test or IEEE1394 test, perform the System  
Board Troubleshooting Procedures in Section 2.4.  
2. If an error is detected on the floppy disk test, perform the FDD Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.5.  
3. If an error is detected on the hard disk test, perform the HDD Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.6.  
4. If an error is detected on the keyboard test, perform the Keyboard Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.7.  
5. If an error is detected on the display test, perform the Display Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.8.  
6. If an error is detected on the test for the touch pad function, perform the Touch Pad  
Troubleshooting Procedures in Section 2.9.  
7. If an error is detected on the CD-ROM/DVD-ROM test, perform the Optical Drive  
Troubleshooting Procedures in Section 2.10.  
8. If an error is detected on the modem test, perform the Modem Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.11.  
9. If an error is detected on the LAN test, perform the LAN Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.12.  
10. If an error is detected on the sound test, perform the Sound Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.13.  
11. If an error is detected on the Wireless LAN test, perform the Wireless LAN  
Troubleshooting Procedures in Section 2.14.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
The power supply controller controls many functions and components. To determine if the  
power supply is functioning properly, start with Procedure 1 and continue with the other  
Procedures as instructed. The procedures described in this section are:  
Procedure 1: Power Status Check  
Procedure 2: Error Code Check  
Procedure 3: Connection Check  
Procedure 4: Charging Check  
Procedure 5: Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Power Status Check  
The following icons indicate the power supply status:  
Battery icon  
DC IN icon  
The power supply controller displays the power supply status with the Battery icon and the  
DC IN icon as listed in the tables below.  
Table 2-1 Battery icon  
Battery icon  
Power supply status  
Lights orange  
Battery is charged and the external DC is input. It has no relation with  
ON/OFF of the system power.  
Lights green  
Battery is fully charged and the external DC is input. It has no relation  
with ON/OFF of the system power.  
Blinks orange  
The battery level is low while the system power is ON.  
(even intervals)  
Doesn’t light  
Any condition other than those above.  
Table 2-2 DC IN icon  
DC IN icon  
Lights green  
Blinks orange  
Doesn’t light  
Power supply status  
DC power is being supplied from the AC adapter.  
Power supply malfunction*1  
Any condition other than those above.  
*1 When the power supply controller detects a malfunction, the DC IN icon  
blinks orange. It shows an error code.  
2-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
When the icon is blinking, perform the following procedure.  
1. Remove the battery pack and the AC adapter.  
2. Re-attach the battery pack and the AC adapter.  
If the icon is still blinking after the operation above, check the followings:  
Check 1 If the DC IN icon blinks orange, go to Procedure 2.  
Check 2 If the DC IN icon does not light, go to Procedure 3.  
Check 3 If the battery icon does not light orange or green, go to Procedure 4.  
NOTE: Use the following supplied AC adapter (G71C0002SB10, G71C0004A410,  
G71C00043310, G71C00049310 or G71C00049410).  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
Procedure 2  
Error Code Check  
If the power supply microprocessor detects a malfunction, the DC IN icon blinks orange.  
The blink pattern indicates an error as shown below.  
Start  
Off for 2 seconds  
Error code (8 bit)  
“1”  
ON for one second  
ON for half second  
Off for half second  
“0”  
Interval between data bits  
The error code begins with the least significant digit.  
Example:  
Error code 13h (Error codes are given in hexadecimal format.)  
Check 1 Convert the DC IN icon blink pattern into the hexadecimal error code and  
compare it to the tables below. Then go to Check 2.  
Error code  
1*h  
Where Error occurs  
Adapter (AC Adapter, DS)  
2*h  
1st battery  
3*h  
2nd battery  
4*h  
S3V output  
E5V output  
E3V output  
PPV output  
1R8-B1V output  
PPV output  
PTV output  
1R5-E1V output  
PGV output  
VG1R8-P1V output  
PTV output  
-
5*h  
6*h  
7*h  
8*h  
9*h  
A*h  
B*h  
C*h  
D*h  
E*h  
F*h  
2-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
DC power supply (AC adapter)  
Error code  
Meaning  
10h  
11h  
12h  
13h  
14h  
AC Adapter output voltage is over 16.5V.  
Common Dock output voltage is over 16.5V.  
Current from the DC power supply is over 7.00A.  
Current from the DC power supply is over 0.5A when there is no load.  
Abnormal current has been sensed.  
Main Battery  
Error code  
Meaning  
22h  
23h  
Main battery discharge current is over 0.5A when there is no load.  
Main battery charge current is over 3.9A when AC adapter is not  
connected.  
24h  
25h  
Abnormal current has been sensed.  
Main battery charge current is over 0.3A.  
Second Battery  
Error code  
Meaning  
32h  
33h  
Second battery discharge current is over 0.5A when there is no load.  
Second battery charge current is over 3.9A. when AC adapter is not  
connected.  
34h  
35h  
Abnormal current has been sensed.  
Second battery charge current is over 0.3A.  
S3V output (P60)  
Error code  
Meaning  
40h  
45h  
46h  
S3V voltage is 3.47V or less when the computer is powered on/off.  
S3V voltage is 3.14V or less when the computer is powered on.  
S3V voltage is 3.14V or less when the computer is booting up.(CV  
support)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
E5V output (P61)  
Error code  
Meaning  
50h  
51h  
52h  
53h  
E5V voltage is over 6.00V when the computer is powered on/off.  
E5V voltage is 4.50V or less when the computer is powered on.  
E5V voltage is 4.50V or less when the computer is booting up.  
E5V voltage is over 4.50V when the computer is powered off. (EV power  
is off)  
54h  
E5V voltage is 4.50V or less when the computer is powered off. (EV  
power is on)  
E3V output (P62)  
Error code  
Meaning  
60h  
61h  
62h  
63h  
E3V voltage is over 3.96V when the computer is powered on/off.  
E3V voltage is 2.81V or less when the computer is powered on.  
E3V voltage is 2.81V or less when the computer is booting up.  
E3V voltage is over 2.81V when the computer is powered off. (EV  
power is off)  
64h  
E3V voltage is 2.81V or less when the computer is powered off. (EV  
power is on)  
1R5-E1V output (P63: MUX_CH0)  
Error code  
Meaning  
70h  
71h  
72h  
73h  
1R5-E1V voltage is over 1.80V when the computer is powered on/off.  
1R5-E1V voltage is 1.275V or less when the computer is powered on.  
1R5-E1V voltage is 1.275V or less when the computer is booting up.  
1R5-E1V voltage is over 1.275V when the computer is powered off.  
(EV power is off)  
1R8-B1V output (P64)  
Error code  
Meaning  
80h  
81h  
82h  
83h  
84h  
1R8-B1V voltage is over 3.00V when the computer is powered on/off.  
1R8-B1V voltage is 1.53V or less when the computer is powered on.  
1R8-B1V voltage is 1.53V or less when the computer is booting up.  
1R8-B1V voltage is over 1.53V when the computer is powered off.  
1R8-B1V voltage is 1.53V or less when the computer is powered off.  
(BV power is on)  
2-10  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
PPV output (P65)  
Error code  
Meaning  
90h  
91h  
92h  
93h  
PPV voltage is over 1.80V when the computer is powered on/off.  
PPV voltage is 0.56V or less when the computer is powered on.  
PPV voltage is 0.56V or less when the computer is booting up.  
PPV voltage is over 0.56V when the computer is powered off. (PV  
power is off)  
PTV output (P66)  
Error code  
Meaning  
A0h  
A1h  
A2h  
A3h  
PTV voltage is over 1.26V when the computer is powered on/off.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is powered on.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is booting up.  
PTV voltage is over 0.89V or more when the computer is powered off.  
(PV power is off)  
1R5-E1V output (P63: MUX_CH1)  
Error code  
Meaning  
B0h  
B1h  
B2h  
B3h  
1R5-E1V voltage is over 1.80V when the computer is powered on/off.  
1R5-E1V voltage is 1.275V or less when the computer is powered on.  
1R5-E1V voltage is 1.275V or less when the computer is booting up.  
1R5-E1V voltage is over 1.275V when the computer is powered off.  
(EV power is off)  
B4h  
1R5-E1V voltage is 1.275V or less when the computer is powered off.  
(EV power is on)  
PTV output (P73)  
Error code  
Meaning  
C0h  
C1h  
C2h  
C3h  
PTV voltage is over 1.63V when the computer is powered on/off.  
PTV voltage is 0.68V or less when the computer is powered on.  
PTV voltage is 0.68V or less when the computer is booting up.  
PTV voltage is over 0.68V when the computer is powered off.  
(BV power is on)  
C4h  
PTV voltage is 0.68V or less when the computer is powered off.  
(BV power is on)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
PTV output (P75)  
Error code  
Meaning  
D0h  
D1h  
D2h  
D3h  
PTV voltage is over 2.16V when the computer is powered on/off.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is powered on.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is booting up.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or more when the computer is powered off.  
(PV power is off)  
PTV output (P77: MUX_CH1)  
Error code  
Meaning  
E0h  
E1h  
E2h  
E3h  
PTV voltage is over 1.26V when the computer is powered on/off.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is powered on.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is booting up.  
PTV voltage is 0.89V or less when the computer is powered off.  
(PV power is off)  
Check 2 In the case of error code 10h or 12h:  
Make sure the AC adapter and AC power cord are firmly plugged into the  
DC IN 15 V socket and wall outlet. If the cables are connected correctly, go  
to the following step:  
Connect a new AC adapter and AC power cord. If the error still exists, go to  
Procedure 5.  
Check 3 In the case of error code 21h:  
Go to Procedure 3.  
Check 4 For any other errors, go to Procedure 5.  
2-12  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Procedure 3  
Connection Check  
The wiring diagram related to the power supply is shown below:  
Any of the connectors may be disconnected. Perform Check 1.  
Check 1 Make sure the AC adapter and the AC power cord are firmly plugged into the  
DC IN 15 V socket and wall outlet. If these cables are connected correctly, go  
to Check 2.  
Check 2 Replace the AC adapter and the AC power cord with new ones.  
If the DC IN icon does not light, go to Procedure 5.  
If the battery icon does not light, go to Check 3.  
Check 3 Make sure the battery pack is installed in the computer correctly. If the battery  
is properly installed and the battery icon still does not light, go to Procedure 4.  
Procedure 4  
Charging Check  
Check if the power supply controller charges the battery pack properly. Perform the  
following procedures:  
Check 1 Make sure the AC adapter is firmly plugged into the DC IN socket.  
Check 2 Make sure the battery pack is properly installed. If the battery is properly  
installed, go to Check 3.  
Check 3 The battery pack may be completely discharged. Wait a few minutes to charge  
the battery pack while connecting the battery pack and the AC adapter. If the  
battery pack is still not charged, go to Check 4.  
Check 4 The battery’s temperature is too high or low. Return the temperature to normal  
operating condition. If the battery pack is still not charged, go to Check 5.  
Check 5 Replace the battery pack with a new one. If the battery pack is still not charged,  
go to Procedure 5.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.3 Power Supply Troubleshooting  
Procedure 5  
Replacement Check  
The power is supplied to the system board by the AC adapter. If either the AC adapter or  
the system board was damaged, perform the following Checks.  
To disassemble the computer, follow the steps described in Chapter 4, Replacement  
Procedures.  
Check 1 Replace the AC adapter with a new one. If the AC adapter is still not  
functioning properly, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 Replace the DC-IN harness with a new one. If the AC adapter is still not  
functioning properly, perform Check 2.  
Check 3 Replace the system board with a new one.  
2-14  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
This section describes how to determine if the system board is defective. Start with  
Procedure 1 and continue with the other procedures as instructed. The procedures  
described in this section are:  
Procedure 1: Message Check  
Procedure 2: Debug Port Check  
Procedure 3: Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 4: Replacement Check  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Procedure 1  
Message Check  
When the power is turned on, the system performs the Initial Reliability Test (IRT)  
installed in the BIOS ROM. The IRT tests each IC on the system board and initializes it.  
If an error message is shown on the display, perform Check 1.  
If there is no error message, go to Procedure 2.  
If MS-DOS or Windows OS is properly loaded, go to Procedure 4.  
Check 1 If one of the following error messages is displayed on the screen, press the F1  
key as the message instructs. These errors occur when the system configuration  
preserved in the RTC memory (CMOS type memory) is not the same as the  
actual configuration or when the data is lost.  
If you press the F1 key as the message instructs, the SETUP screen appears to  
set the system configuration. If error message (b) appears often when the power  
is turned on, replace the RTC battery. If any other error message is displayed,  
perform Check 2.  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
(f)  
(g)  
*** Bad HDD type ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
*** Bad RTC battery ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
*** Bad configuration ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
*** Bad memory size ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
*** Bad time function ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
*** Bad check sum (CMOS) ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
*** Bad check sum (ROM) ***  
Check system. Then press [F1] key ......  
Check 2 If the following error message is displayed on the screen, press any key as the  
message instructs. If any other error message displays, perform Check 3.  
The following error message appears when data stored in RAM under the  
resume function is lost because the battery has become discharged or the  
system board is damaged. Go to Procedure 3.  
WARNING: RESUME FAILURE.  
PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE.  
2-16  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Check 3 The IRT checks the system board. When the IRT detects an error, the system  
stops or an error message appears.  
If one of the following error messages (1) through (17), (23) or (24) is  
displayed, go to Procedure 4.  
If error message (18) is displayed, go to the Keyboard Troubleshooting  
Procedures in Section 2.7.  
If error message (19), (20) or (21) is displayed, go to the 2.5” HDD  
Troubleshooting Procedures in Section 2.6.  
(1) PIT ERROR  
(2) MEMORY REFRESH ERROR  
(3) TIMER CH.2 OUT ERROR  
(4) CMOS CHECKSUM ERROR  
(5) CMOS BAD BATTERY ERROR  
(6) FIRST 64KB MEMORY ERROR  
(7) FIRST 64KB MEMORY PARITY ERROR  
(8) VRAM ERROR  
(9) SYSTEM MEMORY ERROR  
(10) SYSTEM MEMORY PARITY ERROR  
(11) EXTENDED MEMORY ERROR  
(12) EXTENDED MEMORY PARITY ERROR  
(13) DMA PAGE REGISTER ERROR  
(14) DMAC #1 ERROR  
(15) DMAC #2 ERROR  
(16) PIC #1 ERROR  
(17) PIC #2 ERROR  
(18) KBC ERROR  
(19) HDC ERROR  
(20) HDD #0 ERROR  
(21) HDD #1 ERROR  
(22) TIMER INTERRUPT ERROR  
(23) RTC UPDATE ERROR  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Procedure 2  
Debug Port Check  
Check the D port status by a debug port test. The tool for debug port test is  
shown below.  
Figure 2-2 A set of tool for debug port test  
The test procedures are follows;  
1. Connect the debug test cable to the connector CN3490 of the system board. For  
disassembling to connect the test cable, refer to Chapter 4.  
2. Connect the debug port test cable and RS-232C cross cable to the test board.  
3. Connect the RS-232C cross cable to the PC that displays the results.  
4. Boot the computer in MS-DOS mode.  
5. Execute GETDPORT.COM in the text menu in CPU REAL mode. (Insert the FD  
for starting D port into FDD and input “FD starting drive:>dport”.)  
The D port status is displayed in the following form;  
6. When the D port status is FFFFh (normal status), go to Procedure 3  
7. When the D port status falls into any status in Table 2-3, execute Check 1.  
2-18  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Table 2-3 D port status (1/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
Enabling address line A20 and Clearing a  
software reset bit  
Prohibition of APIC  
Initializing MCHM  
Initializing ICHM  
Initializing Super I/O  
Initializing debug port  
Dummy read of 3rd Bus data  
Setting of printer port  
BTBK_START  
(Only for the model supporting PRT)  
F000H  
Initializing the CH0 of a PIT  
(For HOLD_ON)  
Initializing flags determining whether BIOS  
is rewritten  
CHECK SUM CHECK  
Switching to protected mode  
Examining the checksum of Boot Block  
(Skip when returned to S3)  
HLT when check sum error  
Examining the checksum other than Boot  
Block  
F001H  
BTBK_CALC_CHKSUM_END  
EC/KBC rewrite check  
BIOS rewrite when “rewrite” is requested  
Transition of the process to System BIOS IRT  
when returned to S3  
Key input  
When inputting key, [  
],  
[
],  
[TAB] key check  
F002H  
BTBK_INI_SC_START  
Initializing security controller  
BTBK_INI_SC_ERR  
F003H  
F004H  
F005H  
BTBK_SC_HW_FAILURE  
BTBK_INI_KBC_END  
Checking whether BIOS rewrite is  
requested  
CheckSum error except Boot Block  
when rewrite is requested by user  
Transition to BIOS rewrite  
F006H  
BTBK_ENTER_CHK_BIOS_SIGN  
BIOS signature check  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Table 2-3 D port status (2/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
F007H  
BTBK_ENTER_SYSTEM_BIOS  
Transition to System BIOS IRT  
BIOS Rewite process  
ICHM.D31 Initialization  
DRAM Configuration  
Permission of cache () Only for L1 cache  
MEMORI CLEAR  
F008H  
F009H  
BTBK_INI_MEM_END  
Transition to real moded, Copy BIOS in  
RAM  
BTBK_CHG_RAM_BIOS  
Storing key scan code  
Setting up TASK_1ms_TSC  
BTBK_INI_VGA_END  
Controlling Fan  
F00AH  
Initializing sound systems (For beep  
sound)  
Enabling system speaker  
Canceling mute  
Maximizing volume  
When BIOS,EC/KBC is requested to be  
rewritten  
(Green blinks in 2s cycle (ON:1s, Off: 1s))  
F00BH  
BTBK_CANT_UPDATE_BIOS  
Abnormal BIOS ROM  
Key input  
(Orange blinks in 2s cycle (ON:1s, Off: 1s))  
Disabling USB first  
Sound beep  
Waiting for key input  
Loading  
FDC RESET  
CHGBIOSA.EXE/CHGFIRMA.EXE  
Setting up the parameter for 2HD (1.44MB)  
Loading first sector and Confirming the media  
if it is 2HD (1.44MB)  
Setting up the parameter for 2DD (720KB)  
Searching CHGBIOSA.EXE from route directory  
Calculate starting directory head, sector  
Loading route directory per sector  
2-20  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Table 2-3 D port status (3/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
Searching entry of  
“CHGBIOSA.EXE/CHGFIRMA.EXE” from the  
loaded sector  
Loading EXE header of “CHGBIOSA.EXE  
/CHGFIRMA.EXE”,  
Key input when an error occurred  
Executing “CHGBIOSA.EXE”/”CHGFIRMA.EXE”  
IRT  
F100H  
IRT_START  
Cache controll for HyperThreading  
Disabling cache  
Initializing H/W  
(before recognizing DRAM)  
Initializing MCHM  
Initializing ICH4M.D31.Func0  
Initializing ICH4M.D31.Func1  
Initializing USB.Func0,1,2,7  
Initializing ICH4M.D31.Func3  
Initializing ICH4M.D31.Func5  
Initializing FLUTE  
Initializing the channel 1 of a PIT  
IRT_INI_SPREG_END  
(set 30 µs for refresh interval)  
F101H  
F102H  
Checking type and size of DRAM (at  
Cold boot only)  
When no suport memory is connected, HLT after  
beep  
HLT when DRAM size is 0  
Testing stack area of SM-RAM  
IRT_STACK_TEST_END  
Cache Configuration  
HLT when impossible to use as stack  
Enabling L1 and L2 cache  
(at Cold boot only)  
(HLT when an error occurred)  
Access test of CMOS  
Checking battery level of CMOS  
CheckSum check of CMOS  
Initializing CMOS data (1)  
(Setting of Boot status and IRT Busy Flag, The  
bit left is 0)  
Setting up IRT status  
Storing DRAM size  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Table 2-3 D port status (4/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
F103H  
IRT_RSM_BRANCH  
Resume branch check  
(at Cold boot only)  
Not resuming when a CMOS error occurred  
Not resuming when status code of resume is not  
set  
Checking resume error  
S3 Return error (ICH)  
Resume error 170H RSM_UNKNOWN_ERR  
Checking CheckSum of SM-RAM  
Resume error 173H RSM_SMRAM_ERR  
Checking the change of memory configuration  
Resume error 174H RSM_SYSTEM_ERR  
Checking CheckSum of RAM area of system  
BIOS  
Resume error 179H RSM_RAMBIOS_ERR  
Checking CheckSum of expanded memory  
Resume error 176H RSM_EXTMEM_ERR  
Checking CheckSum of PnP RAM  
Resume error 177H RSM_PNPRAM_ERR  
Processing resume (RESUME_MAIN)  
Return the CPU clock to Low  
Disabling all SMI  
Processing resume error  
Clearing resume status  
Return to ROM  
Send the area from C0000h to EFFFFh to PCI  
(Disabling DRAM)  
Setting up Resume error request  
(HLT when an error occurred)  
Copy ROM/RAM of the System BIOS  
IRT_BIOS_SIGN_CHK  
F104H  
F105H  
BIOS signature check  
(at Cold boot only)  
IRT_CHG_RAM_BIOS_END  
SMRAM initialization  
Checking CPU supporting Hyper-  
Threading  
Microcode Update  
APIC initialization  
Checking the factor of WakeUp  
Rewriting the SMRAM base and  
Storing CPU state map for BIOS  
Enabling SMI only by ASMI  
2-22  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Table 2-3 D port status (5/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
IRT_INI_SMBASE_END  
Details  
F106H  
Initialization of the device Which needs  
initialization before PCI BUS Initialization  
PCI test (at Cold boot only) and Initialization  
Setting test pattern in PIT#0 of Channel 0  
Checking whether test pattern set can be  
read  
Initializing the channel 0 of a PIT  
(set 55ms for the interval of interrupt  
timer)  
Initializing the channel 2 of a PIT  
Testing the channel 1 of a PIT  
(set 664Hz frequency for sound generator)  
(Checking whether refresh signal works  
properly with the cycle of refresh interval  
30µs), HLT when timeout  
Testing the channel 2 of a PIT  
(Checking whether speaker gate works  
properly)  
Measuring the clock speed of a CPU  
Permission of SMI except auto-off function  
Control the excess of the rated input power  
Battery discharge current control (1CmA)  
AC adapter rated over current control  
Dividing procedures for time measuring of IRT  
Setting for clock generator  
Checking the parameter block A  
Initialization of CPU  
Confirming CPU type  
Check the support of Geyserville  
Set the CPU clock to “High”  
IRT_CHK_INI_SYS1_END  
Set Graphics Aperture Size  
F107H  
Storing the configuration of ROM in a  
buffer  
Reading EC version  
Updating the type of flash memory  
Determining what country the computer is  
designed to be used in by DMI data  
Checking the default settings of CMOS  
(When finding Bad Battery, Bad  
CheckSum (ROM, CMOS), set default)  
Initializing ACPI table  
(For executing option ROM)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Table 2-3 D port status (6/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
Initialization of the device needed  
initializing before PCI BUS Initialization  
AC’97 control  
Initializing information of thermal control  
Initializing a KBC  
Turning VGA display off and controlling reset  
Initializing sound function  
Acquiring the computer multiple box status  
HC initialization, Recognition of USB device  
connection and initialization  
Permission/ prohibition of Built-in LAN control  
Initializing a PCI  
Testing a PIC  
Initializing password  
IRT_CHK_INI_SYS2_END  
F108H  
F109H  
Initializing PCI Initializing PCI BUS  
(connecting DS Bus)  
Initializing information of LAN  
Checking the factor of WakeUp  
IRT_INI_PCI_END  
Running a task of waiting for the end of  
INIT_PCI  
Initializing the data in CMOS (2)  
Initializing PnP  
Setting up the setup parameters  
Waiting for the end of multiple box state  
check  
Setting up the hardware parameters  
based on resources  
F10AH  
IRT_MK_SYSRES_END  
Running a task of waiting for the end of  
PnP resource creation  
Serial interrupt control  
(performed before interrupt)  
Initializing PnP hardware  
Initializing PC Card Slots  
Initializing SIO (for models supporting SIO)  
Initializing FIR (for models supporting FIR)  
Making of work for automatic configuration  
Acquisition of PCI IRQ  
PCI automatic configuration  
PCI Configuration  
2-24  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Table 2-3 D port status (7/9)  
D port  
Inspection items  
Details  
Storing of VGA configuration result  
F10BH  
IRT_PCI_CONF_END  
Task generation for waiting  
PCI_CONFIGURATION completion  
Initialization of H/W which is necessary  
after PCI configuration  
Printer port setting (for models supporting  
printer port)  
HDD initialization sequence start  
FDD initialization sequence start (For models  
supporting built-in FDD)  
Enabling power off  
Output code generation  
IRT_CHK_INI_SYS3_END  
FIRST_64KB_CHECK  
IRT_CHK_F64KB_END  
INIT_INT_VECTOR  
IRT_INI_VECT_END  
INIT_NDP  
F10CH  
F10DH  
F10EH  
F10FH  
Checking the first 64KB of memory  
Initializing interrupt vectors  
Initializing a NDP  
IRT_INI_NDP_END  
INIT_SYSTEM  
(Initialization of system)  
Storing CMOS error information in  
IRT_ERR_STS_BUF  
Timer initialization start  
Initializing an EC, and reading battery  
Updating system BIOS (Updating EDID of  
the LCD)  
F110H  
F111H  
IRT_INI_SYS_END  
INIT_DISPLAY  
(Waiting for VGA chip initialization  
completion Initializing VGA BIOS)  
IRT_VGA_POS_START  
VGA POST  
(Waiting for VGA chip initialization  
completion Initializing VGA BIOS)  
F112H  
F113H  
IRT_INI_POST_END  
IRT_INI_DISP_END  
DISP_LOGO  
(Displaying a logo)  
F114H  
F115H  
IRT_DISP_LOGO_END  
SYS_MEM_CHECK  
IRT_SYSTEM_CHK_END  
EXT_MEM_CHECK  
Checking conventional memory (Boot)  
Exception check in protect mode (Cold boot  
only)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Table 2-3 D port status (8/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
Setting up the address of font data for resume  
password  
Setting up the parameters for character repeat  
on a USB keyboard  
Final check of key input during IRT  
Storing of T_SHADOW_RAM_SIZE  
Update of system resource before boot  
Rewriting memory map data for INT15h E820h  
function  
Waiting for AC-Link initialization completion  
Updating of table for DMI  
Waiting for AC-Link initialization completion  
Waiting for the end of writing PSC version on  
BIOS  
Waiting for clock generator setting completion  
(Stops in “F121H” when an error is detected)  
Waiting for the end of serial port initialization  
(for models supporting SIO)  
Canceling NMI mask  
Clearance of the checksum of TIT  
Clearing IRT running flag for runtime  
Update checksum for runtime  
Hibernation branch (for models supporting BIOS  
Hibernation)  
Initialization of Bluetooth (for models supporting  
Bluetooth)  
Check of existence of supported maintenance  
cards  
Prohibition unused PC cards  
Setting of WAKEUP status data for ACPI  
HW initialization before Boot,  
Waiting for initialization completion  
F122H  
F123H  
IRT_SC_INIT_START  
IRT_SC_INIT_END  
Notify the DVI connection status to VGA  
BIOS  
(for models supporting DVI)  
Setting up battery safe mode  
Setting up date  
Waiting for the end of Bluetooth  
initialization  
(for models supporting Bluetooth)  
2-26  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Table 2-3 D port status (9/9)  
D port  
status  
Inspection items  
Details  
Updating DMI Wakeup factor and SM-  
BIOS structure table  
Closing configuration space of PCI devices  
Cache control  
Update of parameter block A  
Process for CPU  
Make the CPU clock to be set by SETUP  
Waiting for the motor off of a disabled HDD  
Final decision of USB FDD drive  
information  
Post processing of PRE_BOOT_SETUP  
Clearing PWRBTN_STS  
Enabling the power button  
IRT_PRE_BOOT_SETUP_END  
IRT_WAIT_DISP_LOGO_START  
Clearing IRT status  
F124H  
F125H  
Updating of checksum for Runtime  
IRT_POST_END  
FFFFH  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.4 System Board Troubleshooting  
Procedure 3  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute the following tests from the Diagnostic Test Menu. These tests check the system  
board. Refer to Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostic, for more information on how to perform  
these tests.  
1. System test  
2. Memory test  
3. Keyboard test  
4. Display test  
5. Floppy Disk test  
6. Printer test  
7. Async test  
8. Hard Disk test  
9. Real Timer test  
10. NDP test  
11. Expansion test  
12. CD-ROM/DVD-ROM test  
13. Only One test  
14. Wireless LAN test  
15. LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 test  
16. Sound test  
If an error is detected during these tests, go to Procedure 4.  
Procedure 4  
Replacement Check  
The system board may be damaged. Disassemble the computer following the steps  
described in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures and replace the system board with a new  
one.  
2-28  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.5 3.5” FDD Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2
2.5 3.5” FDD Troubleshooting  
This section describes how to determine if the 3.5” FDD is functioning properly. Perform  
the steps below starting with Procedure 1 and continuing with the other procedures as  
required.  
Procedure 1: FDD Head Cleaning Check  
Procedure 2: Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 3: Connector Check and Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
FDD Head Cleaning Check  
FDD head cleaning is one option available in the Diagnostic Program.  
Insert the Diagnostics Disk in the external floppy disk drive, turn on the computer and run  
the test. And then clean the FDD heads using the cleaning kit. If the FDD still does not  
function properly after cleaning, go to Procedure 2.  
Detailed operation is given in Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics.  
If the test program cannot be executed on the computer, go to Procedure 3.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.5 3.5” FDD Troubleshooting  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Insert the Diagnostics Disk in the USB FDD, turn on the computer and run the test. Refer  
to Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics, for more information about the diagnostics test  
procedures.  
Make sure the floppy disk is formatted correctly and that the write protect tab is disabled.  
Floppy disk drive test error codes and their status names are listed in Table 2-4. If any  
other errors occur while executing the FDD diagnostics test, go to Check 1.  
Table 2-4 FDD error code and status  
Code  
01h  
02h  
03h  
04h  
06h  
08h  
09h  
10h  
20h  
40h  
60h  
80h  
EEh  
FFh  
Status  
Bad command  
Address mark not found  
Write protected  
Record not found  
Media replaced  
DMA overrun error  
DMA boundary error  
CRC error  
FDC error  
Seek error  
FDD not drive  
Time out error (Not ready)  
Write buffer error  
Data compare error  
Check 1 If the following message is displayed, disable the write protect tab on the  
floppy disk by sliding the write protect tab to “write enable”. If any other  
message appears, perform Check 2.  
Write protected  
Check 2 Make sure the floppy disk is formatted correctly. If it is, go to Procedure 3.  
2-30  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.5 3.5” FDD Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Procedure 3  
Connector Check and Replacement Check  
The USB connector may be disconnected from the system board. Check visually that the  
connector is connected firmly.  
Check 1 Make sure the following cables and connectors are firmly connected to the each  
board.  
(FLGSR PCB)  
CN4630  
CN4632  
USB harness  
(FLGCP PCB)  
System board  
PJ4611  
CN4620  
USB FDD  
CN4622  
(FLKCS PCB)  
PJ4610  
*
CN4611  
CN4612  
FLGSR PCB、FLGCP PCB or FLKCS  
PCB is exclusive choice PCB.  
They are never mounted in the  
same board at the same time.  
System board  
USB FDD  
CN4610  
If any of the connections are loose, reconnect firmly and repeat Procedure 2. If  
there is still an error, go to Check 2.  
Check 2 The USB FDD may be defective or damaged. Replace it with a new one. If the  
FDD is still not functioning properly, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The FLGSR board, FLGCP board or FLGCS board connected to the system  
board may be defective or damaged. Replace it with a new one. If the FDD is  
still not functioning properly, perform Check 4.  
Check 4 Replace the system board with a new one following the steps in Chapter 4,  
Replacement Procedures.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.6 2.5” HDD Troubleshooting  
2.6 2.5” HDD Troubleshooting  
This section describes how to determine if the 2.5” HDD is functioning properly. Perform  
the steps below starting with Procedure 1 and continuing with the other procedures as  
required.  
Procedure 1: Partition Check  
Procedure 2: Message Check  
Procedure 3: Format Check  
Procedure 4: Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 5: Connector Check and Replacement Check  
CAUTION: The contents of the hard disk will be erased when the 2.5” HDD  
troubleshooting procedures are executed. Transfer the contents of the hard disk to  
floppy disks or other storage drive(s). For the backup, refer to the User’s Manual.  
Procedure 1  
Partition Check  
Insert the Toshiba MS-DOS system disk and start the computer. Perform the following  
checks:  
Check 1 Type C: and press Enter. If you cannot change to drive C, go to Check 2. If  
you can change to drive C, go to Procedure 2.  
Check 2 Type FDISK and press Enter. Choose Display Partition Information from the  
FDISK menu. If drive C is listed in the Display Partition Information, go to  
Check 3. If drive C is not listed, return to the FDISK menu and choose the  
option to create a DOS partition or a logical DOS drive on drive C. If the  
problem still exists, go to Procedure 2.  
Check 3 If drive C is listed as active in the FDISK menu, go to Check 4. If drive C is not  
listed as active, return to the FDISK menu and choose the option to set the  
active partition for drive C. Then go to Procedure 2.  
Check 4 Remove the system disk from the FDD and reboot the computer. If the problem  
still exists, go to Procedure 2. Otherwise, the 2.5” HDD is operating normally.  
2-32  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.6 2.5” HDD Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Procedure 2  
Message Check  
When the power is turned on, the system performs the Initial Reliability Test (IRT)  
installed in the BIOS ROM. When the test detects an error, an error message is displayed  
on the screen.  
Make sure of no floppy disk in the FDD. Turn on the computer and check the message on  
the screen. When an OS starts from the 2.5” HDD, go to Procedure 3. Otherwise, start with  
Check 1 below and perform the other checks as instructed.  
Check 1 If any of the following messages appear, go to Procedure 3. If the following  
messages do not appear, perform Check 2.  
HDC ERROR  
or  
HDD #X ERROR(After 5 seconds this message will disappear.)  
Check 2 If either of the following messages appears, go to Check 3. If the following  
messages do not appear, perform Check 5.  
Insert system disk in drive  
Press any key when ready .....  
or  
Non-System disk or disk error  
Replace and press any key when ready  
Check 3 Check SETUP to see whether the Hard Disk option is set to Not used. If it is set  
to Not used, choose another setting and return to Check 1. If it is not set to Not  
used, go to Check 4.  
Check 4 Using the SYS command of the MS-DOS, transfer the system to the 2.5” HDD.  
If the system is not transferred, go to Procedure 3. Refer to the MS-DOS  
Manual for detailed operation.  
If the following message appears on the display, the system program has been  
transferred to the HDD.  
System Transferred  
If an error message appears on the display, perform Check 5.  
Check 5 The 2.5” HDD and the connector of the system board may be disconnected  
(Refer to the steps described in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures for  
disassembling.). Insert the connectors firmly. If they are firmly connected, go to  
Procedure 3.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.6 2.5” HDD Troubleshooting  
Procedure 3  
Format Check  
The computer’s HDD is formatted using the MS-DOS FORMAT program or the physical  
format program of the test program. To format the HDD, start with Check 1 below and  
perform the other steps as required.  
Refer to the MS-DOS Manual for the operation of MS-DOS. For the format by the test  
program, refer to the Chapter 3.  
Check 1 Format an 2.5” HDD using MS-DOS FORMAT command. Type as FORMAT  
C:/S/U.  
If the 2.5” HDD can not be formatted, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 Using the MS-DOS FDISK command, set the 2.5” HDD partition. If the  
partition is not set, go to Check 3. If it is set, format the 2.5” HDD using MS-  
DOS FORMAT command.  
Check 3 Using the Diagnostic Disk, format the 2.5” HDD with a format option (physical  
format). If the HDD is formatted, set the 2.5” HDD partition using MS-DOS  
FDISK command.  
If you cannot format the 2.5” HDD using the Tests and Diagnostic program, go  
to Procedure 4.  
2-34  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.6 2.5” HDD Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Procedure 4  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
The HDD test program is stored in the Diagnostics Disk. Perform all of the HDD tests in  
the Hard Disk Drive Test. Refer to Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics, for more information  
about the HDD test program.  
If an error is detected during the HDD test, an error code and status will be displayed. The  
error codes and statuses are described in Table 2-5. If an error code is not displayed but the  
problem still exists, go to Procedure 5.  
Table 2-5 2.5” Hard disk drive error code and status  
Code  
01h  
02h  
04h  
05h  
07h  
08h  
09h  
0Ah  
0Bh  
10h  
11h  
20h  
40h  
80h  
AAh  
BBh  
CCh  
E0h  
EEh  
DAh  
FFh  
Status  
Bad command  
Address mark not found  
Record not found  
HDC not reset  
Drive not initialized  
HDC overrun error (DRQ)  
DMA boundary error  
Bad sector error  
Bad track error  
ECC error  
ECC recover enable  
HDC error  
Seek error  
Time out error  
Drive not ready  
Undefined error  
Write fault  
Status error  
Access time out error  
No HDD  
Data compare error  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.6 2.5” HDD Troubleshooting  
Procedure 5  
Connector Check and Replacement Check  
The HDD is connected to the connector of the system board. The connecting portion may  
be disconnected. Disassemble the computer following the steps described in Chapter 4,  
Replacement Procedures and perform the following checks to check the connecting  
portion:  
Check 1 Make sure the following connectors are firmly connected to the system board.  
44-pin  
1st HDD  
CN1800  
<System board>  
If the connection is loose, reconnect firmly and repeat Procedure 1. If there is  
still an error, go to Check 2.  
Check 2 The 2.5” HDD may be damaged. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures and check the operation. If  
the problem still exists, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The system board may be damaged. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures.  
2-36  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.7 Keyboard Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.7 Keyboard Troubleshooting  
To determine if the computer’s keyboard is functioning properly, perform the following  
procedures. Start with Procedure 1 and continue with the other procedures as instructed.  
Procedure 1: Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 2: Connector Check and Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute the Keyboard Test (DIAGNOSTIC TEST) and Pressed key display test (ONLY  
ONE TEST) in the Diagnostic Program. Refer to Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics, for  
more information on how to perform the test program.  
If an error occurs, go to Procedure 2. If an error does not occur, keyboard is functioning  
properly.  
Procedure 2  
Connector Check and Replacement Check  
The keyboard or system board may be disconnected or damaged. Disassemble the  
computer following the steps described in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures and  
perform the following checks:  
Check 1 Make sure the keyboard cable is firmly connected to the system board.  
34-pin  
<System board>  
Keyboard  
CN3200  
If the connection is loose, reconnect firmly and repeat Procedure 1. If there is  
still an error, go to Check 2.  
Check 2 The keyboard may be damaged. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures. If the problem still exists,  
perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The system board may be damaged. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.8 Display Troubleshooting  
2.8 Display Troubleshooting  
To check if the computer’s display is malfunctioning or not, follow the troubleshooting  
procedures below as instructed.  
Procedure 1: External Monitor Check  
Procedure 2: Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 3: Connector and Cable Check  
Procedure 4: Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
External Monitor Check  
Connect an external monitor to the computer’s external monitor port, then boot the  
computer. The computer automatically detects the external monitor.  
If the external monitor works correctly, the internal LCD may be faulty. Go to Procedure 3.  
If the external monitor appears to have the same problem as the internal monitor, system  
board may be faulty. Go to Procedure 2.  
Procedure 2  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
The Display Test program is stored in Diagnostics disk. This program checks the display  
controller on system board. Insert the Diagnostics disk in the USB FDD, turn on the  
computer and run the test. Refer to Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics for details. If an error  
is detected, go to Procedure 3.  
2-38  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.8 Display Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
Procedure 3  
Connector and Cable Check  
LCD Module is connected to system board by an LCD/FL cable. FL inverter board is also  
connected to system board by an LCD/FL cable. In addition, fluorescent lamp is connected  
to FL inverter board by HV cable. Their cables may be disconnected from system board or  
FL inverter board. Disassemble the computer following the steps described in Chapter 4,  
Replacement Procedures.  
If the connection is loose, reconnect firmly and restart the computer. If the problem still  
occurs, go to Procedure 4.  
<LCD module>  
Fluorescent lamp  
LCD/FL cable  
HV cable  
<System board>  
<FL inverter>  
CN5000  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.8 Display Troubleshooting  
Procedure 4  
Replacement Check  
Fluorescent lamp, FL inverter, LCD module, HV cable and LCD/FL cable are connected  
to display circuits. Any of these components may be faulty. Refer to Chapter 4,  
Replacement Procedures, for instructions on how to disassemble the computer and then  
perform the following checks:  
If fluorescent lamp does not light, perform Check 1.  
If characters or graphics on the internal display are not displayed clearly,  
perform Check 4.  
If some screen functions do not operate properly, perform Check 4.  
If fluorescent lamp remains lit when the display is closed, perform Check 5.  
Check 1 Replace fluorescent lamp with a new one following the instructions in Chapter  
4, Replacement Procedures and test the display again. If the problem still  
occurs, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 LCD/FL cable may be faulty. Replace FL/LCD cable with a new one following  
the instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedure and test the display again.  
If the problem still occurs, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 FL inverter may be faulty. Replace FL inverter with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedure and test the display again. If  
the problem still occurs, perform Check 4.  
Check 4 LCD module may be faulty. Replace LCD module with a new one following  
the instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedure and test the display again.  
If the problem still occurs, perform Check 5.  
Check 5 System board may be faulty. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedure.  
2-40  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.9 Touch Pad Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.9 Touch Pad Troubleshooting  
To determine whether the Touch Pad is faulty or not, perform the following procedures:  
Procedure 1: Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 2: Connector and Cable Check  
Procedure 1 Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute the Touch pad test (ONLY ONE TEST) in the Diagnostic Program. Refer to  
Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics, for more information on how to perform the test  
program.  
If an error occurs, go to Procedure 2. If an error does not occur, touch pad is functioning  
properly.  
Procedure 2 Connector Check & Replacement Check  
Check 1 Make sure the touch pad cable is firmly connected to the system board.  
<System board>  
Touch pad  
CN3240  
If the connection is loose, reconnect firmly and repeat Procedure 1. If there is  
still an error, go to Check 2.  
Check 2 The touch pad or touch pad cable may be damaged. Replace it with a new one  
following the instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures. If the  
problem still exists, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The system board may be damaged. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.10 Optical Drive Troubleshooting  
2.10 Optical Drive Troubleshooting  
To check if the optical drive is defective or malfunctioning, follow the troubleshooting  
procedures below as instructed.  
Procedure 1 Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 2 Connector Check and Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute the CD-ROM/DVD-ROM Test in the Diagnostic Program. Refer to Chapter 3,  
Tests and Diagnostics for more information on how to perform the test program.  
Prepare the tools before the test. (Refer to tools for implementing the Diagnostics  
procedures on page 2-1.)  
If any error is detected by the test, go to Procedure 2.  
Procedure 2  
Connector Check and Replacement Check  
The optical drive is connected to the system board by the connector. The connector may  
be disconnected from the system board or faulty. Disassemble the computer following the  
steps described in Chapter 4 and perform the following checks:  
Check 1 Make sure the following connector has been firmly connected to the optical  
drive and the system board.  
50-pin  
<System board>  
Optical  
disk drive  
CN1810  
If the connection is loose, reconnect it firmly and return to Procedure 2. If there  
is still an error, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 The optical drive may be faulty. Replace the optical drive with a new one  
following the steps in Chapter 4. If the optical drive is still not functioning  
properly, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The system board may be faulty. Replace it with new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4.  
2-42  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.11 Modem Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.11 Modem Troubleshooting  
To check if the modem is defective or malfunctioning, follow the troubleshooting  
procedures below as instructed.  
Procedure 1 Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 2 Connector Check and Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute Modem test in the LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 test program. Refer to  
Chapter 3, Tests and Diagnostics for more information on how to perform the test program.  
If any error is detected, perform Procedure 2.  
Procedure 2  
Connector Check and Replacement Check  
An MDC (Modem Daughter Card) is used as the modem for this computer. The MDC is  
connected to the system board by connector. If the modem malfunctions, these connections  
may be bad or the MDC or system board might be faulty.  
Disassemble the computer following the steps described in Chapter 4 and perform the  
following checks:  
Check 1 Make sure the MDC has been firmly connected to the CN3010 on the system  
board and the modem harness has been firmly connected to the both connectors  
on the system board and on the modem.  
Modem  
MDC  
jack  
12-pin  
Modem harness  
CN3011  
CN3010  
System board  
If any connector is disconnected, connect it firmly and return to Procedure 1. If  
there is still an error, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 The Modem jack may be faulty. Replace it with a new one. If the modem  
function is still not working properly, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The MDC may be faulty. Replace it with a new one following the steps in  
Chapter 4. If the modem function is still not working properly, perform Check  
4.  
Check 4 The system board may be faulty. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.12 LAN Troubleshooting  
2.12 LAN Troubleshooting  
To check if the computer’s LAN is defective or malfunctioning, follow the troubleshooting  
procedures below as instructed.  
Procedure 1 Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 2 Connector Check and Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute LAN test in the LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 test program. Refer to Chapter  
3, Tests and Diagnostics for more information on how to perform the test program.  
If any error is detected by the test, go to Procedure 2.  
Procedure 2  
Connector Check and Replacement Check  
The LAN function is operated by the system board via LAN harness. If the LAN  
malfunctions, the connection among LAN cable, LAN harness and system board is bad or  
they might be faulty.  
Disassemble the computer following the steps described in Chapter 4 and perform the  
following checks:  
Check 1 Check if the LAN cable and LAN harness are connected firmly to the  
connectors.  
LAN harness  
CN4100  
LAN cable  
<System board>  
If they are loose or disconnected, connect it firmly and return to Procedure 1. If  
there is still an error, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 The LAN cable may be defective. Replace the LAN cable with a new one. If  
the problem persist, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The LAN harness may be defective. Replace the LAN harness with a new one.  
If the problem persist, perform Check 4.  
Check 3 The system board may be faulty. Disassemble the computer following the steps  
described in Chapter 4.  
2-44  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.13 Sound Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.13 Sound Troubleshooting  
To check if the sound function is defective or malfunctioning, follow the troubleshooting  
procedures below as instructed.  
Procedure 1 Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Procedure 2 Connector Check  
Procedure 3 Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Diagnostic Test Program Execution Check  
Execute the Sound Test in the Diagnostic Program. Refer to Chapter 3, Tests and  
Diagnostics for more information on how to perform the test program.  
If any error is detected by the test, go to Procedure 2  
Procedure 2  
Connector Check  
The connection of sound system is shown in the following figure.  
Speaker R  
Speaker L  
Sound board cable  
CN6002    
 <System board>  
CN9510  
J6310  
<sound board>  
J6070  
CN6001 CN9500  
Headphone  
Ext. microphone  
As the connection may be bad, disassemble the PC and check each connection.  
If the speakers do not work properly, go to Check 1.  
If the headphone or external microphone does not work properly, go to Check 2.  
Check 1 Make sure the speaker cables are firmly connected to CN6001 and CN6002 on  
the system board. If the sound function does not still work properly, perform  
Procedure 3.  
Check 2 Make sure the sound board is firmly connected to the system board via sound  
board cable. If each function does not still work properly, perform Check 2 of  
Procedure 3.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.13 Sound Troubleshooting  
Procedure 3  
Replacement Check  
Check 1 The speaker may be faulty. Replace it with a new one following the steps in  
Chapter 4. If the problem persists, perform Check 3.  
Check 2 The sound board may be faulty. Replace it with a new one following the steps  
in Chapter 4. If the problem persists, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 The system board may be faulty. Replace it with a new one following the  
instructions in Chapter 4.  
2-46  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.14 Wireless LAN Troubleshooting  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.14 Wireless LAN Troubleshooting  
To check if the computer's Wireless LAN is malfunctioning or not, follow the  
troubleshooting procedures below as instructed.  
Procedure 1: Transmitting-Receiving Check  
Procedure 2: Antennas' Connection Check  
Procedure 3: Replacement Check  
Procedure 1  
Transmitting-Receiving Check  
Before starting the test, make sure the wireless communication switch is set in the ON  
position.  
Check 1 Execute Wireless LAN test program to check the transmitting-receiving  
function of wireless LAN. You will need a second computer that can  
communicate by wireless LAN. Perform the test following the instructions  
described in Chapter 3.  
If the computer passes the test, the function is correctly working. If the  
computer does not pass the test, perform Procedure 2.  
Procedure 2  
Antennas' Connection Check  
The wireless LAN function-wiring diagram is shown below:  
Wireless LAN  
Antenna  
(MAIN)  
<System board>  
CN2200  
Wireless  
LAN card  
Wireless LAN  
Antenna  
(AUX)  
Wirelss LAN antenna cable  
Any of the connections may be disconnected. Disassemble the computer following the  
steps described in Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures, and perform the following checks:  
Check 1 Make sure the wireless communication switch is “On”.  
If the switch is “Off”, turn it “On”. If there is still an error, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 Make sure the Wireless LAN card is firmly connected to the CN2200 on the  
system board.  
If the connector is disconnected, connect it firmly and perform Procedure 1. If  
the Wireless LAN is still not functioning properly, perform Check 3.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 Troubleshooting Procedures  
2.14 Wireless LAN Troubleshooting  
Check 3 Make sure the wireless LAN antenna cables (MAIN and AUX) are firmly  
connected to the connectors on the wirelss LAN card.  
If the wireless LAN antenna cables are disconnected, connect them firmly and  
perform Procedure 1. If the wireless LAN is still not functioning properly, go to  
Procedure 3.  
Procedure 3  
Replacement Check  
The wirelss LAN card, wireless LAN antennas and the system board are may be damaged.  
Refer to Chapter 4, Replacement Procedures, for instructions on how to disassemble the  
computer and then perform the following checks:  
Check 1 The wireless LAN card may be defective or damaged. Replace the wireless  
LAN card with a new one following the instructions in Chapter 4, Replacement  
Procedures. If the problem still exists, perform Check 2.  
Check 2 The wireless LAN antennas may be defective or damaged. Replace the wireless  
LAN antennas with a new one following the instructions in Chapter 4,  
Replacement Procedures. If the problem still exists, perform Check 3.  
Check 3 Replace the system board with a new one following the instructions in Chapter  
4, Replacement Procedures and test the display again.  
2-48  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3  
Tests and Diagnostics  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3
3-ii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Chapter 3  
Contents  
3.1  
The Diagnostic Test................................................................................................... 3-1  
3.1.1  
3.1.2  
3.1.3  
Diagnostics menu ................................................................................. 3-1  
H/W (Hardware) initial information setting tool.................................. 3-3  
Heatrun test program............................................................................ 3-3  
3.2  
Executing the Diagnostic Test ................................................................................... 3-4  
3.2.1  
3.2.2  
3.2.3  
Diagnostics menu (T&D)..................................................................... 3-4  
H/W initial information setting tool..................................................... 3-7  
Heatrun test program............................................................................ 3-7  
3.3  
3.4  
3.5  
3.6  
3.7  
3.8  
3.9  
Setting of the hardware configuration........................................................................ 3-8  
Heatrun Test............................................................................................................. 3-11  
Subtest Names.......................................................................................................... 3-12  
System Test.............................................................................................................. 3-14  
Memory Test............................................................................................................ 3-16  
Keyboard Test.......................................................................................................... 3-17  
Display Test ............................................................................................................. 3-18  
3.10 Floppy Disk Test...................................................................................................... 3-21  
3.11 Printer Test............................................................................................................... 3-23  
3.12 Async Test ............................................................................................................... 3-25  
3.13 Hard Disk Test......................................................................................................... 3-26  
3.14 Real Timer Test........................................................................................................ 3-29  
3.15 NDP Test.................................................................................................................. 3-31  
3.16 Expansion Test......................................................................................................... 3-32  
3.17 CD-ROM/DVD-ROM Test ..................................................................................... 3-34  
3.18 Error Code and Error Status Names......................................................................... 3-35  
3.19 Hard Disk Test Detail Status.................................................................................... 3-38  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST................................................................................................... 3-40  
3.20.1 Program Description .......................................................................... 3-40  
3.20.2 Operations .......................................................................................... 3-40  
3.21 Head Cleaning.......................................................................................................... 3-46  
3.21.1 Function Description.......................................................................... 3-46  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.21.2 Operations .......................................................................................... 3-46  
3.22 Log Utilities ............................................................................................................. 3-47  
3.22.1 Function Description.......................................................................... 3-47  
3.22.2 Operations .......................................................................................... 3-48  
3.23 Running Test............................................................................................................ 3-49  
3.23.1 Function Description.......................................................................... 3-49  
3.23.2 Operations .......................................................................................... 3-49  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities...................................................................................... 3-50  
3.24.1 Function Description.......................................................................... 3-50  
3.24.2 Operations .......................................................................................... 3-51  
3.25 System Configuration .............................................................................................. 3-55  
3.25.1 Function Description.......................................................................... 3-55  
3.25.2 Operations .......................................................................................... 3-56  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)......................................................... 3-57  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)...................................................... 3-61  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)............................................................ 3-66  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program .................................................. 3-70  
3.29.1 LAN test ............................................................................................. 3-70  
3.29.2 Modem test......................................................................................... 3-73  
3.29.3 Bluetooth test...................................................................................... 3-74  
3.29.4 IEEE1394 test..................................................................................... 3-83  
3.30 Sound Test program................................................................................................. 3-84  
3.30.1 Sound (Standard) test ......................................................................... 3-84  
3.30.2 Sound (Legacy) test............................................................................ 3-86  
3.30.3 CD Sound (Standard) test................................................................... 3-87  
3.30.4 CD Sound (Legacy) test ..................................................................... 3-89  
3.31 SETUP ..................................................................................................................... 3-90  
3.31.1 Function Description.......................................................................... 3-90  
3.31.2 Accessing the SETUP Program.......................................................... 3-92  
3-iv  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Tables  
Table 3-1 Subtest names .................................................................................................... 3-12  
Table 3-2 Error codes and error status names.................................................................... 3-35  
Table 3-3 Hard disk controller status register contents...................................................... 3-38  
Table 3-4 Error register contents........................................................................................ 3-39  
Table 3-5 Error message..................................................................................................... 3-76  
Table 3-6 Error code for Bluetooth test (BD_ADDR)....................................................... 3-77  
Table 3-7 Error code for Bluetooth test (BD_ADDR of the DUT).................................... 3-81  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-v  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3-vi  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.1 The Diagnostic Test  
3
3.1 The Diagnostic Test  
This chapter explains how to use the Diagnostic Test programs to test the functions of the  
computer’s hardware modules. The Diagnostics Programs are stored on some Diagnostic  
Disks. There are Service Program Modules (DIAGNOSTIC MENU) and the Test Program  
Modules (DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU) on the Diagnostic Disk.  
The Hardware Initial information Setting Tool consists of some programs that write the  
hardware information or displays the current information of the computer. It is also included  
in one of Diagnostic Disks.  
The heatrun test is automatic test program that executes the some tests successively.  
NOTE: Before starting the diagnostics, be sure to follow these steps:  
1. Check all cables are connected firmly.  
2. Exit any application and close Windows.  
3. Check if [ALL Device] is selected in the “Device Config.” in SET UP menu.  
After checking the diagnostics, be sure to select [Setup by OS] in the  
“Device Config.”  
When replacing the system board, be sure to execute the following procedures.  
1. Before replacing the system board, execute subtest03 "DMI information  
save" in 3.3 Setting of the hardware configuration in order to save the DMI  
information from system board to floppy disk.  
2. After replacing the system board, execute the subtest04 "DMI information  
recovery" and subtest08 "System configuration display" in 3.3 Setting of the  
hardware configuration in order to copy the DMI information and system  
information from the floppy disk.  
3.1.1 Diagnostics menu  
The DIAGNOSTIC MENU consists of the following functions.  
DIAGNOSTIC TEST  
ONLY ONE TEST  
HEAD CLEANING  
LOG UTILITIES  
RUNNING TEST  
FDD UTILITIES  
SYSTEM CONFIGURATION  
EXIT TO MS-DOS  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.1 The Diagnostic Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
The DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU contains the following functional tests:  
SYSTEM TEST  
MEMORY TEST  
KEYBOARD TEST  
DISPLAY TEST  
FLOPPY DISK TEST  
PRINTER TEST  
ASYNC TEST  
HARD DISK TEST  
REAL TIMER TEST  
NDP TEST  
EXPANSION TEST  
CD-ROM/DVD-ROM TEST  
Other tests are:  
Wireless LAN TEST (Wireless LAN TEST disk)  
LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 TEST (LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 TEST  
disk)  
Sound TEST (Sound TEST disk)  
You will need the following equipment to perform some of the Diagnostic test programs.  
USB FDD  
The Diagnostic Disks (T&D for maintenance, LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 for  
maintenance, wireless LAN for maintenance and Sound for maintenance)  
A formatted working disk (Floppy disk test)  
A cleaning kit to clean the floppy disk drive heads (Head Cleaning)  
An external display supporting monitor ID (Expansion test)  
A CD test media TOSHIBA CD-ROM TEST DISK or ABEX TEST CD-ROM  
(Sound test)  
A DVD test media (DVD-ROM TEST DISK TSD-1) (Sound test)  
A music CD (Sound test)  
A CD-RW test media (CD-ROM/DVD-ROM test)  
A USB test module (USB test )  
A USB cable (USB test)  
LAN wraparound connector (LAN test)  
RGB wraparound connector (Expansion test)  
Module cable and RJ11 connector checker (Modem test)  
Headphones (Sound test)  
A microphone (Sound test)  
A PC for wraparound test (Wireless LAN test/Bluetooth test/IEEE1394 test)  
PC card wraparound connector (Expansion test)  
3-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.1 The Diagnostic Test  
3.1.2 H/W (Hardware) initial information setting tool  
The H/W initial information setting tool consists of the following programs.  
Initial configuration  
Region write  
System configuration display  
E2PROM test (MAC/GUID/DMI)  
You will need the following equipment to perform some of the programs.  
The Diagnostics Disk (Main T&D)  
A LAN wraparound connector (E2PROM test)  
3.1.3 Heatrun test program  
The heatrun test starts automatically after the selection.  
You will need the following equipment to perform this program.  
The Diagnostics Disk (Main T&D)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.2 Executing the Diagnostic Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.2 Executing the Diagnostic Test  
To start the DIAGNOSTIC PROGRAM, follow these steps:  
1. Insert the Diagnostics disk in the floppy disk drive.  
2. Release the lock of the power switch and turn on the computer with pressing the F12.  
Select the FDD in the display for selecting booting unit. Then, press Enter and the  
following menu appears.  
Microsoft Windows XX Startup Menu  
---------------------------------------------------------  
1. Repair Main (T&D)  
2. Repair initial config set  
3. Repair Heatrun (T&D)  
Enter a choice: 1  
To start the Diagnostics menu (T&D), press 1 and Enter .  
To start the H/W initial information setting tool, press 2 and Enter.  
To start the Heatrun test, press 3 and Enter.  
3.2.1 Diagnostics menu (T&D)  
After pressing 1 and Enter in the startup menu, the following menu appears.  
TOSHIBA personal computer XXXXXX DIAGNOSTICS  
version X.XX (c) copyright TOSHIBA Corp. 20XX  
DIAGNOSTICS MENU :  
1 - DIAGNOSTIC TEST  
2 – ONLY ONE TEST  
3 -  
4 - HEAD CLEANING  
5 - LOG UTILITIES  
6 - RUNNING TEST  
7 - FDD UTILITIES  
8 - SYSTEM CONFIGURATION  
9 - EXIT TO MS-DOS  
3-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.2 Executing the Diagnostic Test  
NOTE: To exit the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press the Esc key. If a test program is in  
progress, press Ctrl + Break to exit the test program. If a test program is in  
progress, press Ctrl + C to stop the test program.  
Set the highlight bar to 1, and press Enter. The following DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU  
will appear:  
TOSHIBA personal computer XXXXXX DIAGNOSTICS  
version X.XX (c) copyright TOSHIBA Corp. 20XX  
DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU :  
1 - SYSTEM TEST  
2 - MEMORY TEST  
3 - KEYBOARD TEST  
4 - DISPLAY TEST  
5 - FLOPPY DISK TEST  
6 - PRINTER TEST  
7 – ASYNC TEST  
8 - HARD DISK TEST  
9 - REAL TIMER TEST  
10 - NDP TEST  
11 - EXPANSION TEST  
12 - CD-ROM/DVD-ROM TEST  
88 - ERROR RETRY COUNT SET [FDD & HDD]  
99 - EXIT TO DIAGNOSTICS MENU  
Functions 1 through 12 are the Diagnostic Tests. Function 88 sets the floppy disk  
drive and hard disk drive error retry count (0-255).  
To exit the submenu of the Diagnostic Test and returns to the Diagnostics Menu, set  
the highlight bar to function 99 and press Enter.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.2 Executing the Diagnostic Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Select the option you want to execute and press Enter. When you select 1- SYSTEM  
TEST, the following message will appear:  
SYSTEM TEST NAME XXXXXX xxxxxxx DIAGNOSTIC TEST VX.XX  
[Ctrl]+[Break] ; test end  
[Ctrl]+[C]  
;key stop  
SUB-TEST : XX  
PASS COUNT : XXXXX  
WRITE DATA : XX  
ADDRESS  
ERROR COUNT: XXXXX  
READ DATA : XX  
: XXXXXX STATUS  
: XXX  
SUB-TEST MENU :  
01 - ROM checksum  
02 – Fan ON/OFF  
03 - Geyserville  
04 - Quick charge  
05 - DMI read  
99 - Exit to DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU  
NOTE: The menu displayed by your computer may be slightly different from the one  
shown above.  
Select the desired subtest number from the subtest menu and press Enter. The following  
message will appear:  
TEST LOOP : YES (or NO)  
ERROR STOP : YES (or NO)  
Use the right and left arrow keys to move the cursor to the desired option.  
Selecting YES of TEST LOOP increases the pass counter by one, each time the test cycle  
ends and restarts the test cycle.  
Selecting NO returns the process to the subtest menu after the test is complete.  
3-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.2 Executing the Diagnostic Test  
Use the up and down arrow keys to move the cursor to “ERROR STOP”.  
Use the right and left arrow keys to move the cursor to the desired option and press Enter.  
Selecting YES of ERROR STOP stops the test program when an error is found and displays  
the operation guide on the right side of the display screen as shown below:  
ERROR STATUS NAME [[ HALT OPERATION ]]  
1: Test end  
2: Continue  
3: Retry  
These three selections have the following functions respectively:  
1. Terminates the test program and exits to the subtest menu.  
2. Continues the test.  
3. Restarts the test from the error.  
Selecting NO keeps the test running even if an error is found. When an error occurred, the  
error status is displayed and one error is added to the error counter.  
Table 3-1 in section 3.5 describes the function of each test on the subtest menu. Table 3-2 in  
section 3.19 describes the error codes and error status for each error.  
3.2.2 H/W initial information setting tool  
After selecting this test, the following menu appears in the display.  
###################################################################  
######  
H/W initial information setting tool VX.XX  
######  
###################################################################  
*
*
*
*
*
*
1 ………………………… Initial configuration  
2 ………………………… Region write  
3 ………………………… DMI information save  
4 ………………………… DMI information recovery  
8 ………………………… System configuration display  
9 ………………………… E2PROM test (MAC/GUID/DMI)  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*******************************************************************  
... Press test number[1-4,8,9] ?  
For more details on this test, refer to the section 3.4.  
3.2.3 Heatrun test program  
Heatrun test starts executing the same subtest as 3.24 RUNNING TEST.  
For more details on this test, refer to the section 3.4.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.3 Setting of the hardware configuration  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.3 Setting of the hardware configuration  
To execute this program, select 2-Repair initial config testin the startup  
menu, press Enter and follow the directions on the screen. The H/W initial information  
setting tool consists of four subtests. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want to  
execute and press Enter.  
Subtest 01  
Initial configuration  
This subtest executes the following items and shows their contents in the  
display. When an item ends normally, the program proceeds automatically to  
the next one. When an error is found, the program stops and waits for key  
input. (After solving the problem, the program executes the item again.)  
Setting of the CPU set table  
Setting of the micro code  
Setting of the EHSS  
Inputting and writing of DMI information  
When the DMI information is displayed, the following messages  
appear in order. Input each information. (If you do not replace the  
PCB, the DMI information should not be changed.)  
1. “Enter Model Name?” is displayed. Input the computer’s model  
name and press Enter. (e.g. DynaBook)  
2. “Enter Version Number?” is displayed. Input the computer’s  
version number and press Enter. (e.g. PC18070C313S)  
3. “Enter Serial Number?” is displayed. Input the computer’s serial  
number and press Enter. (e.g. 12345678)  
4. “Enter Model Number?” is displayed. Input the computer’s sales  
model number and press Enter. (e.g. PP200-AAAAA)  
5. “Enter Bundle Number?” is displayed. Input the computer’s  
PCN/Bundle number and press Enter.  
(e.g. PMSREQ3Q34H/S0123456789)  
6. “Write data OK (Y/N)?” is displayed. To write the DMI  
information to the Flash ROM, press Y, and then Enter.  
7. “Create DMIINFO TXT (Y/N)?” is displayed. Press Y, then the  
DMI information (text data) is written to the Floppy disk, etc.  
3-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.3 Setting of the hardware configuration  
Setting of the HWSC  
Setting of the UUID  
Display of the DMI information (including UUID)  
Setting of DVD region code (Yes/No)  
After completion of the above settings, H/W configuration & DMI  
information are appeared in order. Check the contents and press Enter.  
Subtest 02  
Region write  
This subtest executes the setting of the region code for DVD drive based on  
the destination of the machine.  
When the region code is already written, test ends without setting.  
The following message appears in the display after setting the region code.  
Press any key to return to the H/W initial information setting tool menu.  
***********************************  
*******  
It completed  
*******  
***********************************  
*
*
Press any key to continue...  
Subtest 03  
DMI information save  
NOTE: Before replacing the system board, be sure to execute this subtest and save the  
DMI information to the floppy disk.  
This is one of tools to copy the DMI information to a new PCB after  
replacing.  
This subtest saves all the DMI data in a floppy disk.  
Subtest 04  
DMI information recovery  
NOTE: 1. After replacing the system board, be sure to execute this subtest and copy the  
DMI information to a new system board.  
2. Since the data of UUID is updated every time when this subtest, DMI  
information recovery, is done, the saved UUID data is not written  
This is one of tools to copy the DMI information to a new PCB after  
replacing.  
This subtest writes all the DMI data in the floppy disk into the new PCB.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.3 Setting of the hardware configuration  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 08  
System configuration display  
This subtest displays the information of the system configuration.  
Confirm the contents and press Enter.  
For more details on the system configuration information, refer to 3.26  
"System configuration".  
Subtest 09  
E2PROM test (MAC/GUID/DMI)  
It checks whether the MAC address, GUID of IEEE1394 and DMI  
information are written.  
3-10  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.4 Heatrun Test  
3.4 Heatrun Test  
To execute this program, select 3-Repair heatrunin the startup menu, press Enter.  
After selecting this test, the same subtests as 3.24 RUNNING TEST is executed  
successively.  
For more details on the procedure and test content, refer to RUNNING TEST.  
When the heatrun test ends, following message appears in the display.  
************************************************  
HEATRUN TEST END  
************************************************  
Press any key to continue...  
Press any key and return to the startup menu.  
NOTE: The test result (Errorlog.txt) is stored in the floppy disk. The result is displayed in  
the same way as 3.23 LOG UTILITIES. For more detail in the display, refer to  
LOG UTILITIES.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.5 Subtest Names  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.5 Subtest Names  
Table 3-1 lists the subtest names for each test program in the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU.  
Table 3-1 Subtest names (1/2)  
No.  
Test Name  
SYSTEM  
Subtest No.  
Subtest Name  
ROM checksum  
1
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
Fan ON/OFF  
Geyserville  
Quick charge  
DMI read  
Conventional memory  
Protected Mode  
Protected Mode (cache off)  
Cache memory (on/off)  
Stress  
2
MEMORY  
3
4
KEYBOARD  
DISPLAY  
Pressed key code display  
01  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
VRAM read/write for VGA  
Gradation for VGA  
Gradation for LCD  
Gradation & Mode test for VGA  
All dot on/off for LCD  
“H” pattern display  
LCD Brightness  
5
FLOPPY DISK  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
Sequential read  
Sequential read/write  
Random address/data  
Write specified address  
Read specified address  
3-12  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.5 Subtest Names  
Table 3-1 Subtest names (2/2)  
No.  
Test Name  
PRINTER  
Subtest No.  
Subtest Name  
6
01  
02  
03  
Ripple pattern  
Function  
[Not supported]  
Wrap around  
01  
02  
03  
FIR/SIR Point to point (send)  
FIR/SIR Point to point (receive)  
Wrap around (board)  
7
8
ASYNC  
[Not supported]  
HARD DISK  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
Sequential read  
Address uniqueness  
Random address/data  
Cross talk & peak shift  
Partial Read  
Write specified address  
Read specified address  
Sequential write  
W-R-C specified address  
9
REAL TIMER  
01  
02  
03  
Real time  
Backup memory  
Real time carry  
10  
11  
NDP  
01  
NDP test  
EXPANSION  
01  
03  
PCMCIA wrap around [Not supported]  
RGB monitor ID  
13  
CD-ROM  
/DVD-ROM  
01  
02  
03  
04  
Sequential read  
Read specified address  
Random address/data  
RW 1point W/R/C  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.6 System Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.6 System Test  
To execute the System Test select 1 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter and  
follow the directions on the screen. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want to execute  
and press Enter.  
Subtest 01  
ROM Checksum  
This subtest executes a checksum test of the BIOS ROM (range: F0000h to  
FFFFFh, 64KB) on the System Board.  
Subtest 02  
Fan ON/OFF  
This subtest turns on/off the fan motor by force with Fan ON/OFF commands.  
The following message will appear.  
Fan number select (1;FAN#1, 2;FAN#2, 0; FAN#1&#2) ?  
To check the CPU fan, press 1 and Enter.  
To check the VGA fan, press 2 and Enter.  
To check both CPU fan and VGA fan, press 0 and Enter.  
The following message will appear.  
*** Test Fan Revolution 0000RPM start  
Make sure the fan does not rotate, then press Enter.  
The following message will appear.  
*** Test Fan Revolution Low speed Start  
Make sure the fan rotates at low speed, then press Enter.  
The following message will appear.  
*** Test Fan Revolution High speed Start  
Make sure the fan rotates at high speed, then press Enter.  
After a while, the fan rotating will stop.  
Geyserville  
Subtest 03  
Subtest 04  
If the CPU supports Gerserville (SpeedStep), this Subtest checks that the CPU  
operating clock speed can be changed.  
Quick Charge  
3-14  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.6 System Test  
This subtest checks the status for the quick charge.  
DMI read  
Subtest 05  
This subtest displays the information in the Flash-ROM in the following  
format.  
*** DMI Data Display Ver X.XX ***  
Model Name  
: XXXXXXXXXXX  
Version Number : XXXXXXXXXXXX  
Serial Number : XXXXXXXX  
Model Number  
UUID Number  
: XXXXXX-XXXXX  
: XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX  
Press [Enter] to EXIT  
To exit this subtest and return to the SYSTEM test menu, press Enter.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.7 Memory Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.7 Memory Test  
To execute the Memory Test, select 2 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter  
and follow the directions on the screen. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want to  
execute and press Enter.  
Subtest 01  
Conventional memory  
This subtest writes a constant data to conventional memory (0 to 640 KB),  
then reads the new data and compares the result with the original data.  
Subtest 02  
Protected Mode  
NOTE: The CONFIG.SYS file must be configured without expanded memory manager  
programs such as EMM386.EXE, EMM386.SYS or QEMM386.SYS. Also, the  
HIMEM.SYS must be deleted from the CONFIG.SYS file.  
This subtest writes constant data and address data (from 1MB to maximum  
MB), and reads the new data and compares the result with the original data.  
Subtest 03  
Subtest 04  
Protected Mode (Cache off)  
This subtest executes the same way as the subtest 02 with the cache off.  
Cache Memory  
To test the cache memory, a pass-through write-read comparison of ‘5Ah’  
data is run repeatedly to the test area (‘7000’:’Program’ size to ‘7000’:’7FFF’  
(32 KB)) to check the hit-miss ratio (on/off status) for CPU cache memory.  
One test takes 3 seconds.  
Number of misses < Number of hits OK  
Number of misses Number of hits Fail  
Subtest 05  
Stress  
Data (from 1MB to the maximum MB) is written from the 16KB write buffer  
to the 16KB read buffer and compared the data in the buffers. The read buffer  
starts from 0001 and the comparison is continued with the following read  
buffer addresses: 0001, 0003, 0005, 0007, 0009, 000b, 000d and 000f.  
3-16  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.8 Keyboard Test  
3.8 Keyboard Test  
To execute the Keyboard Test, select 3 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter  
and follow the directions on the screen. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want to  
execute and press Enter.  
Subtest 01  
Pressed key code display  
When a key is pressed, the scan code, character code, and key top name are  
displayed on the screen in the format shown below. The Ins Lock, Caps  
Lock, Num Lock, Scroll Lock, Alt, Ctrl, Left Shift, and Right Shift  
keys are displayed in reverse screen mode when pressed. The scan codes,  
character codes, and key top names are shown in Appendix D.  
KEYBOARD TEST IN PROGRESS 302000  
Scan code  
Character code =  
Keytop  
Ins Lock Caps Lock Num Lock  
Alt Ctrl Left Shift Right Shift  
PRESS [Enter] KEY  
=
=
Scroll Lock  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.9 Display Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.9 Display Test  
To execute the Display Test, select 4 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter  
and follow the directions on the screen. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want to  
execute and press Enter.  
Subtest 01  
VRAM read/write for VGA  
This subtest writes the constant data (AAh and 55h) to the video RAM. The  
data is read and compared to the original data.  
Subtest 02  
Gradation for VGA  
This subtest displays four colors: red, green, blue and white from left to right  
across the screen from black to maximum brightness. The display below  
appears on the screen, when this subtest is executed.  
To exit this subtest and return to the DISPLAY TEST menu, press Enter.  
Subtest 03  
Gradation for LCD  
This subtest displays bands of gradations for mixed colors, then for red, green,  
and blue. Next, it displays eight solid colors full screen: red, semi-red, green,  
semi-green, blue, semi-blue, white, and semi-white. Each color displays for  
three seconds.  
3-18  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.9 Display Test  
Subtest 04  
Gradation & Mode test for VGA  
This subtest displays gradations for following modes. To change the mode,  
press Enter.  
[Mode 12]  
[Mode 13]  
[Mode 3]  
[Mode 111 640*480 64K]  
[Mode 112 640*480 16M]  
[Mode 114 800*600 64K]  
[Mode 115 800*600 16M]  
[Mode 117 1024*768 64K]  
[Mode 118 1024*768 16M]  
The display below appears on the screen when this subtest is executed.  
(Display example: Mode 12)  
To exit this subtest and return to the DISPLAY TEST menu, press Enter after  
displaying the Mode 118.  
Subtest 05  
All dot on/off for LCD  
This subtest displays an all-white screen then an all-black screen. The display  
changes automatically every three seconds, then returns to the DISPLAY  
TEST menu.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.9 Display Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 06  
“H” Pattern Display  
This subtest displays a full screen of “H” patterns.  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
HHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHHH  
To exit this subtest and return to the DISPLAY TEST menu, press Enter.  
NOTE: The last row may not be completely filled. This condition does not indicate on  
error.  
Subtest 07  
LCD Brightness  
The LCD brightness changes in the following order:  
Super-Bright —> Bright —> Semi-Bright —> Bright —> Super-Bright  
After displaying with Super-Bright of LCD brightness, return to the  
DISPLAY TEST menu.  
3-20  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.10 Floppy Disk Test  
3.10 Floppy Disk Test  
CAUTION: Before running the floppy disk test, prepare a formatted work disk. Remove  
the Diagnostics Disk and insert the work disk into the FDD. The contents of  
the floppy disk will be erased.  
To execute the Floppy Disk Test, select 5 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press  
Enter and follow the directions displayed on the screen. After selecting the Floppy Disk  
Test from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, messages to execute the test drive number,  
media type and test start truck will be displayed successively. Answer each question with an  
appropriate response to execute the test.  
1. The following message will appear. Select the media mode and start track to be tested,  
then press Enter.  
Test start track  
(Enter:0/dd:00-79) ?  
2. The Floppy Disk test contains five subtests that test the FDD.  
The floppy disk test menu will appear after you select FDD test parameters.  
FLOPPY DISK  
XXXXXXX  
XXX DIAGNOSTIC TEST VX.XX  
[Ctrl]+[Break] : test end  
[Ctrl]+[C]  
: key stop  
SUB-TEST  
: XX  
PASS COUNT : XXXXX  
WRITE DATA : XX  
ERROR COUNT : XXXXX  
READ DATA  
: XX  
ADDRESS  
: XXXXXX STATUS  
: XXX  
SUB-TEST MENU :  
01 - Sequential read  
02 - Sequential read/write  
03 - Random address/data  
04 - Write specified address  
05 - Read specified address  
99 - Exit to DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.10 Floppy Disk Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Select the number of the subtest you want to execute and press Enter. The following  
message will appear during the floppy disk test.  
xxx DIAGNOSTIC TEST VX.XX  
[Ctrl]+[Break] : test end  
FLOPPY DISK IN PROGRESS XXXXXXX  
[Ctrl]+[C]  
: key stop  
SUB-TEST  
: XX  
PASS COUNT : XXXXX  
WRITE DATA : XX  
ERROR COUNT : XXXXX  
READ DATA  
: XX  
ADDRESS  
: XXXXXX STATUS  
: XXX  
When the subtest 04 or 05 is selected, the following messages will appear on the screen.  
Select the test data (subtest 04 only), track number and head number you want to test.  
Test data  
Track No.  
Head No.  
?? (subtest 04 only)  
??  
?
Subtest 01  
Sequential read  
This subtest performs a Cyclic Redundancy Check (CRC) that continuously  
reads all the tracks (track: 0 to 39/0 to 79) on a floppy disk.  
Subtest 02  
Sequential read/write  
This subtest continuously writes data pattern B5ADADh to all the tracks  
(track: 0 to 39/0 to 79) on a floppy disk. The data is then read and compared  
to the original data.  
Subtest 03  
Random address/data  
This subtest writes random data to random addresses on all tracks (track: 0 to  
39/0 to 79) on a floppy disk. The data is then read and compared to the  
original data.  
Subtest 04  
Subtest 05  
Write specified address  
This subtest writes the data specified by an operator to a specified track, head,  
and address.  
Read specified address  
This subtest reads data from a track, head, and address specified by an  
operator.  
3-22  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.11 Printer Test  
3.11 Printer Test  
To execute the Printer Test, select 6 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter and  
follow the directions on the screen. The following messages will appear after selecting the  
Printer Test from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU. Answer each of the questions with an  
appropriate response to execute the test.  
NOTE: An IBM compatible printer must be connected to the system to execute this test.  
Also, printer port wraparound connector must be connected.  
The following message will appear, after selecting the subtest 01 to 03 of the printer test:  
channel#1 = XXXXh  
channel#2 = XXXXh  
channel#3 = XXXXh  
Select the channel number (1-3) ?  
The printer I/O port address is specified by the XXXXh number. The computer supports  
three printer channels. Select the printer channel number, and press Enter to execute the  
selected subtest.  
Subtest 01  
Ripple Pattern  
This subtest prints characters for codes 20h through 7Eh line-by-line while  
shifting one character to the left at the beginning of each new line.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.11 Printer Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 02  
Function  
This subtest is for IBM compatible printers, and tests the following functions:  
Normal print  
Double-width print  
Compressed print  
Emphasized print  
Double-strike print  
All characters print  
This subtest prints the various print types shown below:  
Subtest 03  
Wraparound  
NOTE: To execute this subtest, a printer wraparound connector must be connected to the  
computer’s printer port.  
This subtest checks the output and bi-directional modes of the data control  
and status lines through the parallel port wraparound connector  
(34M741986G01). (Both output and bi-directional modes are tested.)  
3-24  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.12 Async Test  
3.12 Async Test  
To execute the Async Test, select 7 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter and  
follow the directions displayed on the screen. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want  
to execute and press Enter.  
Subtests 01 and 02 require the following data format:  
Method:  
Speed:  
Data:  
Asynchronous  
38400BPS  
8 bits and one parity bit (EVEN)  
Data pattern: 20h to 7Eh  
Subtest 01  
FIR/SIR Point to point (send)  
NOTE: To execute subtests 01 and 02, each computer must have access to the other  
computer’s infrared port.  
This subtest sends 20h through 7Eh data to the receive side, then receives the  
sent data and compares it to the original data through the FIR/SIR port.  
Subtest 02  
Subtest 03  
FIR/SIR Point to point (receive)  
This subtest is used with subtest 01 described above. This subtest receives the  
data from the send side, then sends the received data through the FIR/SIR  
port.  
Wraparound (on board)  
NOTE: To execute this subtest, a RS-232C wraparound connector must be connected to  
the RS-232C port.  
This subtest checks the data send/receive function through the wraparound  
connector.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.13 Hard Disk Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.13 Hard Disk Test  
To execute the Hard Disk Test, select 8 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter,  
and follow the directions on the screen.  
CAUTION: The contents of the hard disk will be erased when subtest 02, 03, 04, 06,  
08,or 09 is executed. Before running the test, the customer should transfer  
the contents of the hard disk to floppy disk or another hard disk. If the  
customer has not or cannot perform the back-up, create back-up disks as  
described below.  
Check to see if the Microsoft Create System Disks Tools (MSCSD.EXE) still  
exists in the System Tools Folder. (This tool can be used only once.) If it  
exists, use it to back up the pre-installed software, then use the Backup  
utility in the System Tools folder to back up the entire disk, including the  
user’s files.  
Refer to the operating system instructions.  
When a 2nd HDD is installed, the following messages will appear after selecting the hard  
disk test from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU.  
Test drive number select  
(1:HDD#1, 2:HDD#2, 0:HDD#1&2) ?  
1. Input the number of HDD test and press Enter.  
2. This message is used to select the error dump operation when a data compare error is  
detected. Select 1 or 2.  
Data compare error dump (1:no, 2:yes)  
3. This message is used to select whether or not the HDD status is displayed on the  
screen. The HDC status is described in section 3.19. Select 1 or 2.  
Detail status display (1:no, 2:yes)  
3-26  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.13 Hard Disk Test  
4. The Hard Disk Test message will appear after you respond to the Detail Status  
prompt. Select the number of the subtest you want to execute and press Enter. The  
following message will appear during each subtest.  
XXX DIAGNOSTIC TEST VX.XX  
[Ctrl]+[Break] : test end  
HARD DISK TEST XXXXXXX  
[Ctrl]+[C]  
: key stop  
SUB TEST  
: XX  
PASS COUNT : XXXXX  
WRITE DATA : XX  
ERROR COUNT : XXXXX  
READ DATA  
STATUS  
: XX  
ADDRESS  
: XXXXXX  
: XXX  
The first three digits of the ADDRESS indicate which cylinder is being tested, the  
fourth digit indicates the head and the last two digits indicate the sector.  
The first digit of the STATUS number indicates the drive being tested and the last  
two digits indicate the error status code as explained in table 3-2 of the section 3.18.  
Subtest 01  
Sequential read  
This subtest is a sequential reading of all the tracks on the HDD starting at  
track 0. When all the tracks on the HDD have been read, the test starts at the  
maximum track and reads the tracks on the HDD sequentially back to track 0.  
Subtest 02  
Address uniqueness  
This subtest writes unique address data to each sector of the HDD track-by-  
track. The data written to each sector is then read and compared with the  
original data. There are three ways the HDD can be read:  
1. Forward sequential  
2. Reverse sequential  
3. Random  
Subtest 03  
Random address/data  
This subtest writes random data in a random length to random addresses. This  
data is then read and compared to the original data.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.13 Hard Disk Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 04  
Cross talk & peak shift  
This subtest writes eight types of worst pattern data (listed below) to a  
cylinder, then reads the data while moving from cylinder to cylinder. (Test the  
data interference in the neighbor track)  
Worst pattern data  
Cylinder  
‘B5ADAD’  
‘4A5252’  
‘EB6DB6’  
‘153449’  
’63B63B’  
‘9C49C4’  
‘2DB6DB’  
‘D25344’  
0 cylinder  
1 cylinder  
2 cylinder  
3 cylinder  
4 cylinder  
5 cylinder  
6 cylinder  
7 cylinder  
Subtest 05  
Partial Read  
This subtest reads 1GB data that is in minimum, middle and maximum  
address of the HDD area.  
Subtest 06  
Subtest 07  
Write specified address  
This subtest writes specified data to a specified cylinder and head on the  
HDD.  
Read specified address  
This subtest reads data, which has been written to a specified cylinder and  
head on the HDD.  
Subtest 08  
Subtest 09  
Sequential write  
This subtest writes specified 2-byte data to all of the cylinders on the HDD.  
W-R-C specified address  
This subtest writes data to a specified cylinder and head on the HDD, then  
reads the data and compares it to the original data.  
3-28  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.14 Real Timer Test  
3
3.14 Real Timer Test  
To execute the Real Timer Test, select 9 from the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU, press Enter  
and follow the directions on the screen. Move the highlight bar to the subtest you want to  
execute and press Enter.  
Subtest 01  
Real time  
A new date and time can be input during this subtest. To execute the real time  
subtest, follow these steps:  
1. Select subtest 01 and the following messages will appear:  
Current date : XX-XX-XXXX  
Current time : XX:XX:XX  
Enter new date:  
PRESS [ENTER] KEY TO EXIT TEST  
2. If the current date is not correct, input the correct date at the “Enter new  
date” prompt and press Enter.  
3. The following messages will appear:  
Current date : XX-XX-XXXX  
Current time : XX:XX:XX  
Enter new time:  
PRESS [ENTER] KEY TO EXIT TEST  
4. If the current time is not correct, input the correct time in 24-hour format.  
To enter ":", press Shift + ;. The time is updated.  
To exit the test, press Enter.  
Subtest 02  
Backup memory  
This subtest checks the following backup memories:  
Writes 1-bit of “on” data (01h through 80h) to address 0Eh through 7Fh  
Writes 1-bit of “off” data (FEh through 7Fh) to address 0Eh through 7Fh  
Writes the data pattern AAh and 55h to the address 0Eh to 7Fh  
Then the subtest reads and compares this data with the original data.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.14 Real Timer Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 03  
Real time carry  
CAUTION: When this subtest is executed, the current date and time are erased.  
This subtest checks the real time clock increments, making sure the date and  
time are displayed in the following format:  
Current date : 12-31-1999  
Current time : 23:59:58  
The real time increments are automatically executed and the following is  
displayed:  
Current date : 01-01-2000  
Current time : 00:00:00  
PRESS [Enter] KEY TO EXIT TEST  
To exit the test, press Enter.  
3-30  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.15 NDP Test  
3.15 NDP Test  
To execute the NDP test, select 10 from the DIAGNOSTICS TEST MENU, press Enter and  
follow the directions on the screen.  
Subtest 01  
NDP  
This test checks the following functions of NDP:  
Control word  
Status word  
Bus  
Addition  
Multiplication  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.16 Expansion Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.16 Expansion Test  
To execute the expansion test, select 11 from the DIAGNOSTICS TEST MENU, press Enter  
and follow the directions on the screen.  
Subtest 01  
PCMCIA wraparound  
NOTE: To execute this subtest, the PC card wraparound connector is required.  
This subtest checks the following signal line of the PC card slot:  
Address line  
REG#, CE#1, CE#2 line  
Data line  
Speaker line  
Wait line  
BSY#, BVD1 line  
This subtest is executed in the following order:  
Sub#  
Address  
Good  
Bad  
Contents  
Address line  
REG#, CE#1, CE#2  
nn=A0, 90, 80, 00  
01  
00001  
00001  
nn  
nn  
xx  
xx  
02  
00002  
ww  
rr  
Data line  
ww=write data, rr=read  
data  
03  
04  
05  
00003  
00004  
00005  
––  
40,80  
nn  
––  
xx  
xx  
Speaker line  
Wait line (40<xx<80)  
Other lines (BSY#, BVD1)  
NN=21, 00  
NOTE: Select the subtest number01, The following message will appear:  
Test slot number select (1:slot0, 2:slot1, 0:slot0&1)?  
3-32  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.16 Expansion Test  
Subtest 02  
RGB monitor ID  
NOTE: To execute this subtest, RGB monitor ID wraparound connector is required.  
The wiring diagram of the connector is described in Appendix F.  
Connect a wraparound connector to CRT monitor for the test of ID acquisition.  
This subtest is executed by using VESA command.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.17 CD-ROM/DVD-ROM Test  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.17 CD-ROM/DVD-ROM Test  
To execute the CD-ROM/DVD-ROM test, select 13 from the DIAGNOSTICS TEST MENU,  
press Enter and follow the directions on the screen.  
NOTE: For the subtest 01, 02 and 03, use the TOSHIBA CD-ROM TEST DISK TDY-01 or  
ABEX TEST CD-ROM TCDR-702 and DVD-ROM TEST DISK TSD-1. For the  
subtest 04, use a CD-RW on the market.  
Subtest 01  
Sequential read  
This subtest is a sequential reading of one-block units (2K bytes) of all the  
logical addresses.  
Subtest 02  
Subtest 03  
Read specified address  
This subtest reads one-block data from a specified address.  
Random address/data  
This subtest reads one-block data and multi-block data from random addresses  
200 times.  
Subtest 04  
RW 1point W/R/C  
This subtest writes, reads and compares data at one point on a CD/RW media.  
3-34  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.18 Error Code and Error Status Names  
3.18 Error Code and Error Status Names  
Table 3-2 lists the error codes and error status names for the Diagnostic Test.  
Table 3-2 Error codes and error status names (1/3)  
Device name  
(Common)  
Error code  
Error status name  
Data Compare Error  
FF  
ROM - CHECKSUM ERROR  
System  
01  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
ROM - SERIAL ID WRITE ERROR  
ROM - NOT SUPPORTED PS-SYSTEM  
ROM - SENSING ERROR(AC-ADAPT)  
ROM - SENSING ERROR(1st Batt)  
ROM - SENSING ERROR(2nd Batt)  
ROM - THORMISTOR ERROR(1)  
ROM - THORMISTOR ERROR(2)  
ROM - THORMISTOR ERROR(3)  
Memory  
01  
02  
DD  
RAM - PARITY ERROR  
RAM - PROTECTED MODE NO CHANGE'  
RAM - CACHE MEMORY ERROR  
Keyboard  
FE  
FD  
F0  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F9  
FA  
EF  
ED  
USB - GET DESCR.ERROR (FIRST)  
USB - SET ADDRESS ERROR  
HUB - GET DESCR.ERROR(Top 8B)  
HUB - GET DESCR.ERROR (Whole)  
HUB - SET CONFIGURATION ERROR  
HUB - GET DESCR.ERROR(DESCR.)  
HUB - SET FEATURE ERROR(P ON)  
HUB - GET STATUS ERROR  
HUB - SET FEATURE ERROR(RESET)  
HUB - CLEAR FEATURE ERROR  
HUB - CLEAR FEATURE1 ERROR  
HUB - SET FEATURE ERROR(Enab.)  
HUB - CLEAR FEATURE2 ERROR  
USB - OVER CURRENT ERROR  
USB - GET DESCR.ERROR(SECOND)'  
Display  
EE  
VRAM SIZE NOT SUPPORT  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.18 Error Code and Error Status Names  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Table 3-2 Error codes and error status names (2/3)  
Device name  
FDD  
Error code  
Error status name  
01  
02  
03  
04  
08  
09  
10  
20  
40  
80  
60  
06  
EE  
FDD - BAD COMMAND ERROR  
FDD - ADDRESS MARK NOT FOUND  
FDD - WRITE PROTECTED  
FDD - RECORD NOT FOUND  
FDD - DMA OVERRUN ERROR  
FDD - DMA BOUNDARY ERROR  
FDD - CRC ERROR  
FDD - FDC ERROR  
FDD - SEEK ERROR  
FDD - TIME OUT ERROR  
FDD - NOT DRIVE ERROR  
FDD - MEDIA REMOVED  
FDD - WRITE BUFFER ERROR  
Printer  
01  
08  
10  
20  
40  
80  
PRT - TIME OUT  
PRT – FAULT  
PRT - SELECT LINE  
PRT - OUT OF PAPER  
PRT - POWER OFF  
PRT - BUSY LINE  
ASYNC  
01  
02  
04  
08  
10  
20  
40  
80  
88  
05  
06  
RS232C - [DTR ON] TIME OUT  
RS232C - [CTS ON] TIME OUT  
RS232C - [RX READY] TIME OUT  
RS232C - [TX FULL] TIME OUT  
RS232C - PARITY ERROR  
RS232C - FRAMING ERROR  
RS232C - OVERRUN ERROR  
RS232C - LINE STATUS ERROR  
RS232C - MODEM STATUS ERROR  
SIR - TIME OUT ERROR  
FIR - TIME OUT ERROR  
HDD  
05  
07  
09  
0B  
BB  
08  
01  
02  
04  
10  
20  
40  
80  
11  
AA  
HDD - HDC NOT RESET ERROR  
HDD - DRIVE NOT INITIALIZE  
HDD - DMA BOUNDARY ERROR  
HDD - BAD TRACK ERROR  
HDD - UNDEFINED ERROR  
HDD - OVERRUN ERROR (DRQ ON)  
HDD - BAD COMMAND ERROR  
HDD - ADDRESS MARK NOT FOUND  
HDD - RECORD NOT FOUND ERROR  
HDD - ECC ERROR  
HDD - HDC ERROR  
HDD - SEEK ERROR  
HDD - TIME OUT ERROR  
HDD - ECC RECOVER ENABLE  
HDD - DRIVE NOT READY  
3-36  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.18 Error Code and Error Status Names  
Table 3-2 Error codes and error status names (3/3)  
Device name  
(HDD)  
Error code  
Error status name  
CC  
E0  
0A  
EE  
DA  
12  
HDD - WRITE FAULT  
HDD - STATUS ERROR  
HDD - BAD SECTOR  
HDD - ACCESS TIME ERROR  
HDD - NO HDD  
HDD - DMA CRC ERROR  
NDP  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
NDP - NO CO-PROCESSOR  
NDP - CONTROL WORD ERROR  
NDP - STATUS WORD ERROR  
NDP - BUS ERROR  
NDP - ADDITION ERROR  
NDP - MULTIPLAY ERROR  
EXPANSION  
C1  
C3  
C4  
C5  
C6  
C7  
C8  
CB  
CC  
CE  
CF  
ADDRESS LINE ERROR  
CE#1 LINE ERROR  
CE#2 LINE ERROR  
DATA LINE ERROR  
WAIT LINE ERROR  
BSY# LINE ERROR  
BVD1 LINE ERROR  
ZV-Port ERROR  
NO PCMCIA  
CARD TYPE ERROR  
ZV_CONT# ERROR  
CD-ROM  
/DVD-ROM  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
09  
11  
20  
40  
80  
90  
B0  
BAD COMMAND  
ILLEGAL LENGTH  
UNIT ATTENTION  
MEDIA CHANGE REQUEST  
MEDIA DETECTED  
ADDITIMAL SENSE  
BOUNDARY ERROR  
CORRECTED DATA ERROR  
DRIVE NOT READY  
SEEK ERROR  
TIME OUT  
RESET ERROR  
ADDRESS ERROR  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.19 Hard Disk Test Detail Status  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.19 Hard Disk Test Detail Status  
When an error occurs in the hard disk test, the following message is displayed:  
HDC status = XXXXXXXX  
Detailed information about the hard disk test error is displayed on the screen by an eight-digit  
number. The first four digits represent the hard disk controller (HDC) error status number and  
the last four digits are not used.  
The hard disk controller error status is composed of two bytes; the first byte displays the  
contents of the HDC status register in hexadecimal form and the second byte displays the  
HDC error register.  
The contents of the HDC status register and error register are listed in Tables 3-3 and 3-4.  
Table 3-3 Hard disk controller status register contents  
Bit  
Name  
Description  
7
BSY  
(Busy)  
“0” … HDC is ready.  
“1” … HDC is busy.  
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DRY  
(Drive ready)  
“0” … Hard disk drive is not ready to accept any command.  
“1” … Hard disk drive is ready.  
DWF  
(Drive write fault)  
“0” … DWF error is not detected.  
“1” … Write fault condition occurred.  
DSC  
“0” … The hard disk drive heads are not settled over a track.  
“1” … The hard disk drive heads are settled over a track.  
(Drive seek complete)  
DRQ  
(Data request)  
“0” … Drive is not ready for data transfer.  
“1” … Drive is ready for data transfer.  
COR  
(Corrected data)  
“0” … Not used  
“1” … Correctable data error is corrected.  
IDX  
(Index)  
“0” … Not used  
“1” … Index is sensed.  
ERR  
“0” … Normal  
(Error)  
“1” … The previous command was terminated with an error.  
3-38  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.19 Hard Disk Test Detail Status  
Tables 3-4 Error register contents  
Bit  
Name  
Description  
7
BBK  
“0” … Not used  
(Bad block mark)  
“1” … A bad block mark is detected.  
6
UNC  
“0” … There is no uncorrectable data error.  
(Uncorrectable)  
“1” … Uncorrectable data error has been detected.  
5
4
——  
Not used  
IDN  
“0” … Not used  
(Identification)  
“1” … There is no ID field in the requested sector.  
3
2
——  
Not used  
ABT  
“0” … Not used  
(Abort)  
“1” … Illegal command error or command abort.  
1
TK0  
(Track 0)  
“0” … The hard disk found track 0 during a recalibrate  
command.  
“1” … The hard disk could not find track 0 during a  
recalibrate command.  
0
——  
Not used  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
3.20.1 Program Description  
This program tests the unique functions of this model.  
3.20.2 Operations  
Select test 2 from the DIAGNOSTIC MENU and press Enter. The following menu appears  
in the display.  
#################################################################  
########  
ONLY ONE TEST Menu (XXXXXXXXX)  
#######  
#################################################################  
*
*
* 1 ............ Pressed Key Display  
* 2 ............ Touch Pad  
* 3 ............ GP Button  
* 4 ............ Kill Switch  
* 5 ............ USB  
* 6 ............ Docker Dock/Undock  
* 7 ............ LED  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
* 9 ............ Exit to Common Test  
*
*****************************************************************  
.... Press test number [1-7, 9]?  
Select the subtest number you want to test and press Enter.  
To return to the DIAGNOSTIC TEST menu, select 9 and press Enter.  
3-40  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
Subtest 01  
Pressed key display  
When you execute this subtest, the keyboard layout is drawn on the display as  
shown below. When any key is pressed, the corresponding key on the screen  
changes to the key character that was pressed. Holding a key down enables the  
auto-repeat function that causes the key’s display character to blink.  
Press Del + Enter to end the test.  
IF TEST OK, Press [Dell][Enter]key  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 02  
Touch Pad  
This subtest checks the functions of the touch pad as shown below.  
A) Direction and parameter  
B) Switching function check.  
This test displays the response from the touch pad and touch pad switch. When  
moving your finger on the touch pad towards the upper left, the <POINTING>  
display changes according to the following illustration. If a touch pad switch is  
pressed, the <BUTTONS> displays appear on the right side one by one. The  
parameters appear above the <BUTTONS> (1) or (2) corresponding to the  
pressed touch pad switch highlights. To end this subtest, press two touch pad  
switches at the same time.  
3-42  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
Subtest 03  
GP Button  
This subtest checks if the GP buttons work properly.  
The following message appears in the display.  
Press [Console] Button!  
Press the indicated button, then following message will appear in the display.  
Press [Console] Button! OK  
As the same way, press the indicated buttons and run the button test.  
If wrong key is pressed, following message will appear in the display.  
Press [Console] Button! NG  
Functionkeys = XXXX  
Press any key!  
Pressing any key, indication of pressing button will appear in the display again.  
Unless the right button is pressed, this operation is repeated.  
After checking all the button (Console Button, Presentation Button, Intternet  
Button), return to the ONLY ONE TEST menu automatically.  
Subtest 04  
Kill Switch  
This subtest checks if the Wireless communication switch works properly.  
If the test is started with the switch ON, following message appears in the  
display.  
Kill switch is set to a start position (OFF)  
Slide the switch to OFF position. Then, following message appears in the  
display.  
KILL SWITCH ON !!  
Slide the switch to ON position. Then, following message appears in the  
display.  
KILL SWITCH OFF !!  
After Sliding the switch to OFF position, return to the ONLY ONE TEST  
menu automatically.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest 05  
USB  
NOTE: When executing this subtest, USB test module and USB cable must be connected.  
This subtest checks if USB port works properly.  
The following menu appears in the display.  
#################################################################  
########  
ONLY ONE TEST Menu (XXXXXXXXX)  
#######  
#################################################################  
*
*
* 0 ............ Port 0 (Right side)  
* 1 ............ Port 1 (Left side)  
* 2 ............ Port 2 (Back side)  
* 9 ............ Exit to Only One Menu  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*****************************************************************  
.... Press test number[0-2, 9] ?  
Connect the USB test module and USB cable to the computer.  
Input the port test number and press Enter.  
OK message appears in the display if the test ends without a defective.  
NG message appears in the display if a defective is found during the test.  
Confirm the connection of cable, then execute the test again.  
Press 9 and return to ONLY ONE TEST menu.  
Subtest 06  
Docker Dock/Undock  
This subtest is executed with Advanced Port Replicator 3 installed.  
Press Enter while pushing the eject button of the Advanced Port Replicator 3  
after the following message appears.  
Slide Eject-SW, and press [Enter] Key  
Press Enter without pushing the eject button of the Advanced Port Replicator  
3 after the following message appears.  
Release Eject-SW, and press [Enter] Key  
If the test ends successfully, the display returns to the ONLY ONE TEST menu.  
When the display returns to the ONLY ONE TEST menu, remove the  
Advanced Port Replicator 3 from the computer.  
3-44  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.20 ONLY ONE TEST  
Subtest 07  
LED  
This subtest checks if each LED lights properly.  
The following message appears in the display in order. Follow the instructions  
in the display to execute the test.  
[HDD Access LED test]  
Confirm the LED of HDD status blinks properly.  
Press any key and following message appears in the display.  
[Caps/Num/Overlay BT/W-LAN LED test]  
Confirm each LED lights properly.  
(1) Press [Caps Lock ] key ! ...Caps  
(on/off)  
(2) Press [Fn + F10 ] key ! ...Arrow (on/off)  
(3) Press [Fn + F11 ] key ! ...Num  
(4) Slide [BT/W-LAN switch L&R]!  
(on/off)  
(on/off)  
Press Enter and following message appears in the display.  
Check [DC-IN]&[Power]&[Main Battery]LED= Green  
Check if the each LED lights in the same color as the message in the display  
(Message switches Green<-> Orange).  
Press Enter and return to the ONLY ONE TEST menu.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.21 Head Cleaning  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.21 Head Cleaning  
3.21.1 Function Description  
This function cleans the heads in the FDD by executing a series of head load/seek and read  
operations. A cleaning kit is necessary to perform this program.  
3.21.2 Operations  
1. Selecting test 4 from the DIAGNOSTIC MENU and pressing Enter displays the  
following messages:  
DIAGNOSTICS - FLOPPY DISK HEAD CLEANING : VX.XX  
Mount cleaning disk(s) on drive(s).  
Press any key when ready.  
2. Remove the Diagnostics Disk from the FDD, then insert the cleaning disk and press  
Enter.  
3. When the cleaning startmessage appears, the FDD head cleaning has begun.  
4. The display automatically returns to the DIAGNOSTIC MENU when the program is  
completed.  
3-46  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.22 Log Utilities  
3.22 Log Utilities  
3.22.1 Function Description  
This function logs error information generated while a test is in progress and stores the results  
in RAM. This function can store data on a floppy disk or output the data to a printer.  
The error information is displayed in the following order:  
1. Error count (CNT)  
2. Test name, Subtest number (TS-No)  
3. Pass count (PASS)  
4. Error status (STS)  
5. FDD/HDD or memory address (ADDR)  
6. Write data (WD)  
7. Read data (RD)  
8. HDC status (HSTS)  
9. Error status name (ERROR STATUS NAME)  
If the power switch is turned off, the error information will be lost.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.22 Log Utilities  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.22.2 Operations  
1. Select 5 and press Enter in the DIAGNOSTIC MENU, logs error information into  
RAM or onto a floppy disk. The error information is displayed in the following  
format:  
XXXXX ERRORS  
CNT TS-NO PASS STS ADDR WDRDHSTS [ERROR STATUS NAME]  
001 FDD 02 0000 103 00001 00000000 FDD-WRITE PROTECTED  
001 FDD 01 0000 180 00001 00000000 FDD-TIME OUT ERROR  
Address  
Error status  
HDC status  
Pass count  
Read data  
Subtest number  
Error status name  
Write data  
Test name  
Error count  
[[1:Next,2:Prev,3:Exit,4:Clear,5:Print,6:FD Log Read,7:FD Log Write]]  
2. The error information displayed on the screen can be manipulated by the following  
number keys:  
The 1 key scrolls the display to the next page.  
The 2 key scrolls the display to the previous page.  
The 3 key returns to the Diagnostic Menu.  
The 4 key erases all error log information in RAM.  
The 5 key outputs the error log information to a printer.  
The 6 key reads the log information from a floppy disk.  
The 7 key writes the log information to a floppy disk.  
3. In the case of “error retry OK,” a capital “R” will be placed at the beginning of the  
error status. However, it is not added to the error count.  
3-48  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.23 Running Test  
3.23 Running Test  
3.23.1 Function Description  
This function automatically executes the following tests in sequence:  
1. System test (subtest 01)  
2. Memory test (subtests 01, 02, 06)  
3. Display test (subtest 01)  
4. Real timer test (subtest 02)  
5. HDD test (subtests 01)  
The system automatically detects the number of floppy disk drives connected to the computer  
for the FDD test.  
3.23.2 Operations  
1. Select 6 from the Diagnostic Menu and press Enter, the following messages will  
appear in the display in order.  
FDD write/read test (Y/N) ?  
Printer wrap around test (Y/N) ?  
Serial wrap around test (Y/N) ?  
CD-ROM/DVD-ROM test (Y/N) ?  
2. To execute the test, press Y (yes) and Enter. To cancel the test, press N (no) and  
Enter. If you execute the selectable test, follow the indication message in the display.  
3. After setting the selectable test, the test starts automatically. To terminate the program,  
press Ctrl + Break.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities  
3.24.1 Function Description  
This function formats the FDD, copies the floppy disk and displays the dump list for both the  
FDD and HDD.  
1. FORMAT  
NOTE: This program is only for testing a floppy disk drive. The option is different from  
the Toshiba MS-DOS FORMAT command.  
This program can format a floppy disk in the following formats:  
(a) 2DD: Double-sided, double-density, double-track, 96/135 TPI, MFM mode,  
512 bytes, 9 sectors/track.  
(b) 2HD: Double-sided, high-density, double-track, 96/135 TPI, MFM mode, 512  
bytes, 18 sectors/track.  
2. COPY  
This program copies data from a source floppy disk to a target floppy disk.  
3. DUMP  
This program displays the contents of the floppy disk and the designated sectors of  
the hard disk on the display.  
4. HDD ID READ  
This program reads the hard disk ID and displays hard disk information.  
3-50  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities  
3.24.2 Operations  
1. Selecting 7 from the DIAGNOSTIC MENU and pressing Enter displays the  
following message:  
[ FDD UTILITIES ]  
1 - FORMAT  
2 - COPY  
3 - DUMP  
4 – HDD-ID READ  
9 - EXIT TO DIAGNOSTICS MENU  
2. FORMAT program  
(a) Selecting FORMAT displays the following message:  
DIAGNOSTICS - FLOPPY DISK FORMAT : VX.XX  
Drive number select (1:A, 2:B) ?  
(b) Select a drive number to display the following message:  
Type select (0:2DD, 3:2HD) ?  
(c) Select a media/drive type number and press Enter. A message similar to the  
one below will be displayed:  
Warning : Disk data will be destroyed.  
Insert work disk into drive A:  
Press any key when ready.  
(d) Remove the Diagnostics Disk from the FDD, insert the work disk and press  
any key.  
The following message will be displayed when the FDD format is executed:  
[ FDD TYPE ] : TRACK = XXX  
[ FDD TYPE ] : HEAD = X  
[ FDD TYPE ] : SECTOR = XX  
Format start  
[[track, head = XXX X]]  
After the floppy disk is formatted, the following message will appear:  
Format complete  
Another format (1:Yes/2:No) ?  
(e) Typing 1 displays the message from step (c) above. Typing 2 returns the test  
to the DIAGNOSTIC MENU.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3. COPY program  
(a) When COPY is selected, the following message appears:  
FLOPPY DISK FORMAT & COPY : VX.XX  
Type select (0:2DD,3:2HD) ?  
(b) Selecting a media/drive type number will display a message similar to the one  
below:  
Insert source disk into drive A:  
Press any key when ready.  
(c) Remove the Diagnostics Disk from the FDD, insert the source disk and press  
any key. The following message will appear, indicating the program has  
started.  
[ FDD TYPE ] : TRACK  
= XXX  
[ FDD TYPE ] : HEAD = X  
[ FDD TYPE ] : SECTOR = XX  
Copy start  
[[ track,head = XXX X ]]  
(d) The following message will appear.  
Insert target disk into drive A:  
Press any key when ready.  
(e) Remove the source disk from the FDD, then insert a formatted work disk and  
press any key. The following message will appear and start copying to the  
target disk.  
[[ track,head = XXX X ]]  
(f) When the amount of data is too large to be copied in one operation, the  
message from step (b) is displayed again. After the floppy disk has been  
copied, the following message will appear:  
Copy complete  
Another copy (1:Yes/2:No) ?  
(g) To copy another disk, type 1 and the message from step (a) is displayed again.  
Entering 2 returns the test program to the DIAGNOSTIC MENU.  
3-52  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities  
4. DUMP program  
(a) When DUMP is selected, the following message appears:  
DIAGNOSTICS-HARD DISK & FLOPPY DISK DUMP : VX.XX  
Drive type select (1:FDD, 2:HDD) ?  
(b) Select a drive type. If 2:HDDis selected, the display will go to step (h). If  
1:FDDis selected, the following message will appear:  
Select drive number (1:A, 2:B) ?  
(c) Select a drive number and the following message will be displayed.  
Format type select (1:2DD, 3:2HD) ?  
(d) If 3:2HDis selected, the following message will appear. Select a media mode.  
2HD media mode (1:1.20MB, 2:1.44MB, 3:1.23MB)?  
(e) The following message will appear:  
Insert source disk into drive A:  
Press any key when ready.  
(f) Insert a source disk and press any key and the following message will appear:  
—— Max. address ——  
[Track ] = XXXX  
[Head ] = XX  
[Sector] = XX  
Track number ????  
(g) Set the track number, head number and sector number you want to dump. The  
system will access the disk and dump a list. Then the message shown in (k)  
will appear.  
(h) The following message will appear when selecting 2:HDDin (a).  
Select drive number (1:C, 2:D) ?  
(i) Select a drive number and the following message will be displayed.  
---Max. address ---  
[LBA ] = XXXXXXXXX  
LBA number ????????  
(j) Set the LBA number you want to dump. The system will access the disk and  
dump a list.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.24 Floppy Disk Drive Utilities  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
(k) The following message will appear. To finish the dump, select 3.  
Press number key (1:up,2:down,3:end) ?  
(l) The following message will appear. Selecting 2 returns to the FDD  
UTILITIES MENU.  
Another dump (1:Yes,2:No) ?  
5. HDD ID READ program  
Selecting HDD ID displays the following HDD ID configuration:  
[HDD ID Read (VX.XX)] [Drive #1]  
Model No. = XXXXXXX  
[Drive #2]  
= XXXXXXX  
NOTE: Only when a 2nd HDD is installed, [Drive #2] message appears in the display.  
Press Enter to return to the FDD UTILITIES MENU.  
3-54  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.25 System Configuration  
3
3.25 System Configuration  
3.25.1 Function Description  
The System Configuration program contains the following configuration information for the  
computer:  
1. Processor Type [Code/L2 cache]  
2. Chip set [VRAM]  
3. BIOS ROM version [1st ID, 2nd ID]  
4. Boot ROM version  
5. EC total version  
6. PS Microprocessor version  
7. SVP parameter version [Panel/Manufacture code/Product code]  
8. Micro code revision [Processor number]  
9. Total Memory Size [Conventional memory]  
10. Battery code  
11. HWSC  
12. FSB [Voltage]  
13. The number of printer ports  
14. The number of ASYNC ports  
15. Math co-processors  
16. Floppy Disk Drive [Track/Head/Sector]  
17. Hard Disk Drive [Sector/Drive size/Manufacture code]  
18. Optical Disk Drive [Maker/Drive type/Manufacture code/Product code]  
19. T&D total version  
20. Date/Time  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.25 System Configuration  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.25.2 Operations  
Select 8 from the DIAGNOSTIC MENU and press Enter. Then, the following system  
configuration appears in the display.  
System Configuration Display: Ver X.XX [Machine Name???]  
* - Processor Type  
* - Chip set  
* - BIOS ROM Version  
* - BOOT ROM Version  
* - EC Total Version  
* - PS Micon Version  
* - SVP Par. Version  
* - Micro code Revision = VX.XX  
* - Total Memory Size = XXXXXXMB (Conventional Memory = XXXKB)  
* - Battery Code  
* - HWSC  
* - FSB  
= XXXXXX-XXXXXMHz  
= XXXXXX  
Code = XX  
L2 Cache = XXXXXKB  
VRAM = XXXXMB  
= VX.XX  
= VX.XX  
= VX.XX  
= VX.XX  
= VX.XX  
1st ID = XXH, 2nd ID = XXH  
(Panel=XXXXXXXXX, Manu=XXXX, Prod=XXXX)  
(Processor=XXXh)  
= XXXXXXXXXXXX  
= XXXXXXX  
= XXXXXMHz (Voltage = XEh)  
LPT1 = XXXX LPT2 = XXXX LPT3 = XXXX  
COM1 = XXXX COM2 = XXXX COM3 = XXXX  
* - X Printer Adapter  
* - X ASYNC Adapter  
* - X Math CO-Processor  
* - X Floppy Disk Drive(s)  
* - X Hard Disk Drive(s)  
Track = XX  
Head = XX, Sector = XX  
#1 Sectors = XXXXX, (XXXXX GB) [XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX]  
#2 Sectors = XXXXX, (XXXXX GB) [XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX]  
* - ODD  
= XXXX XXXXXXXX XXXXXXXXX [XXXXXXXXXXXX]  
* - T&D Total Version = VX.XX  
Press [Enter] Key  
[Date = XXXX-YY-ZZ, XX:YY:ZZ]  
Press Enter to return to the DIAGNOSTIC MENU.  
3-56  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)  
This section describes how to perform the wireless LAN transmitting-receiving test (Intel-  
made Calexico 802.11b/g). To execute the wireless LAN test, use the Diagnostics disk for  
wireless LAN test. Finish the tests of the Main test program by selecting 99 - EXIT TO  
DIAGNOSTICS MENU in the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU. Then in the DIAGNOSTICS  
MENU, select 9 - EXIT TO MS-DOS.  
Insert the Diagnostics disk for wireless LAN test into the Floppy Disk Drive. Turn on the  
power while pressing U.  
The following menu appears in the display.  
******Intel Calexico 11b/g Card Maintenance test Menu*******  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
1 : SKU check of Module  
2 : MAC Address Check  
*
*
3 : Antenna Check & communication test of 11b mode *  
*
4 : Communication test of 11g mode  
*
*
*
5 : All the tests of Calexico 11g Card  
(SKU & MAC Check, 11b/g communication test)  
*
*
************************************************************  
SELECT TEST No, (1-5):  
To execute the subtest, input the subtest number and press Enter.  
Subtest01  
SKU check of module  
This subtest displays SKU information on the wireless LAN card installed.  
Selecting this subtest, following message will appear in the display. Confirm  
if the right information on the wireless LAN card is described.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Module  
G-code  
: Intel Calexico 802.11b/g (MoW)  
: xxxxxxxxxxxx  
PBA No. : xxxxxx  
*************************************************************  
If a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the display.  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Using a wrong wireless LAN card (Using unspecified card)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection, execute the subtest again.  
MAC Address Check  
Subtest02  
This subtest displays the MAC address. Selecting this subtest, following  
message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
MAC = XXXXXXXXXXXX  
*************************************************************  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
MAC Address Check: OK !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
If a defective is found during the test, following message will appear in the  
display.  
*************************************************************  
ERROR: MAC all 0  
MAC = XXXXXXXXXXXX  
*************************************************************  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
MAC Address Check: NG !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Disappearance of MAC address data  
Checking the connection, execute the subtest again.  
3-58  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)  
Subtest03  
Antenna check & communication test of 11b mode  
Caution: To execute subtest 03-05, use another computer (with Calexico wireless LAN  
card) that can communicate by the wireless LAN as a responder machine to  
perform those tests. Access points are also required. (Access point for 802.11b  
and 802.11g)  
Be sure to turn the wireless communication switch ON before executing  
wireless LAN communication test. (The wireless communication LED lights  
orange.)  
Release the write-protection of floppy disk for the test.  
Setting the responder machine  
Connect the responder machine to the access points (for 802.11b and 802.11g) with a cross  
cable and turn on the access points.  
Insert the floppy disk containing the wireless LAN test program into the FDD of the  
responder machine and turn on the responder machine.  
This subtest checks the connection and communication of wireless LAN  
antenna of Calexico 802.11b mode.  
After finishing the test, OK message will appear in the display. Press any key  
and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the  
display. Press any key and following message will appear in the display.  
Check which antenna (Main/Aux) is defective.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
Main Antenna Test: NG !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Connection of wireless LAN antenna cable (Main/Aux)  
Condition of wireless LAN communication (Interference/obstruction)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection and condition, execute the subtest again.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.26 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made b/g)  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest04  
Communication test of 11g mode  
This subtest checks the communication of wireless LAN antenna of Calexico  
802.11g mode.  
After finishing the test, OK message will appear in the display. Press any key  
and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the  
display. Press any key and following message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
11g Communication Test: NG !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Connection of wireless LAN antenna cable (Main)  
Condition of wireless LAN communication (Interference/obstruction)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection and condition, execute the subtest again.  
All the tests of Calexico 11b/g Card  
Subtest05  
This subtest checks SKU information, MAC address, connection and  
communication of wireless LAN antenna of Calexico 802.11b/g card. The test  
stops at when a defective is found. For more details, refer to each subtest.  
3-60  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)  
This section describes how to perform the wireless LAN transmitting-receiving test (Intel-  
made Calexico 802.11a/b/g). To execute the wireless LAN test, use the Diagnostics disk for  
wireless LAN test. Finish the tests of the Main test program by selecting 99 - EXIT TO  
DIAGNOSTICS MENU in the DIAGNOSTIC TEST MENU. Then in the DIAGNOSTICS  
MENU, select 9 - EXIT TO MS-DOS.  
Insert the Diagnostics disk for wireless LAN test into the Floppy Disk Drive. Turn on the  
power while pressing U.  
The following menu appears in the display.  
************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Intel Calexico2 11a/g Maintenance T&D Menu  
*
*
*
*
1 : SKU check of Module  
2 : MAC Address Check  
*
*
3 : Antenna Check & communication test of 11b mode *  
*
4 : Communication test of 11a mode  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
5 : Communication test of 11g mode  
6 : All the tests of Calexico2 11a/g Card  
(SKU & MAC Check, 11a/b/g communication test)  
************************************************************  
SELECT TEST No, (1-6):  
To execute the subtest, input the subtest number and press Enter.  
Subtest01  
SKU check of module  
This subtest displays SKU information on the wireless LAN card installed.  
Selecting this subtest, following message will appear in the display. Confirm  
if the right information on the wireless LAN card is described.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Module : Intel Calexico 802.11a/g (MoW)  
G-code : xxxxxxxxxxxx  
PBA No. : xxxxxx  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
If a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the display.  
Press any key and following message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
SKU NG !!  
Other Card or Module not found  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Using a wrong wireless LAN card (Using unspecified card)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection, execute the subtest again.  
MAC Address Check  
Subtest02  
This subtest displays the MAC address. Selecting this subtest, following  
message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
MAC = XXXXXXXXXXXX  
*************************************************************  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
MAC Address Check : OK !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
If a defective is found during the test, following message will appear in the  
display.  
*************************************************************  
ERROR: MAC all F  
MAC = XXXXXXXXXXXX  
*************************************************************  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
MAC Address Check : NG !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
3-62  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Disappearance of MAC address data  
Checking the connection, execute the subtest again.  
Antenna check & communication test of 11b mode  
Subtest03  
Caution: To execute subtest 03-06, use another computer (with Calexico wireless LAN  
card) that can communicate by the wireless LAN as a responder machine to  
perform those tests. Access points are also required. (Access point for 802.11a,  
802.11b and 802.11g )  
Be sure to turn the wireless communication switch ON before executing  
wireless LAN communication test. (The wireless communication LED lights  
orange.)  
Release the write-protection of floppy disk for the test.  
Setting the responder machine  
Connect the responder machine to the access points (for 802.11a, 802.11b and 802.11g) with  
a cross cable and turn on the access points.  
Insert the floppy disk containing the wireless LAN test program into the FDD of the  
responder machine and turn on the responder machine.  
This subtest checks the connection and communication of wireless LAN  
antenna of Calexico 802.11b mode.  
After finishing the test, OK message will appear in the display. Press any key  
and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the  
display. Press any key and following message will appear in the display.  
Check which antenna (Main/Aux) is defective.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
Aux Antenna Test : NG !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Connection of wireless LAN antenna cable (Main/Aux)  
Condition of wireless LAN communication (Interference/obstruction)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection and condition, execute the subtest again.  
Communication test of 11a mode  
Subtest04  
This subtest checks the communication of wireless LAN antenna of Calexico  
802.11a mode.  
After finishing the test, OK message will appear in the display. Press any key  
and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the  
display. Press any key and following message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
11a Communication Test : NG !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Connection of wireless LAN antenna cable (Main)  
Condition of wireless LAN communication (Interference/obstruction)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection and condition, execute the subtest again.  
3-64  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.27 Wireless LAN Test Program (Intel-made a/b/g)  
Subtest05  
Communication test of 11g mode  
This subtest checks the communication of wireless LAN antenna of Calexico  
802.11g mode.  
For more details on procedure and contens of this subtest, refer to Subtest04  
Communication test of 11a mode.  
Subtest06  
All the tests of Calexico 11a/b/g Card  
This subtest checks SKU information, MAC address of Calexico 802.11a/b/g  
card, antenna connection and communication test of Calexico 802.11b card  
and communication test of Calexico 802.11a and Calexico 802.11g. The test  
stops at when a defective is found. For more details, refer to each subtest.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)  
This section describes how to perform the wireless LAN transmitting-receiving test (Askey-  
made Atheros b/g, a/b/g).  
Caution: To execute subtest 03-07, use another computer (with Atheros wireless LAN  
card) that can communicate by the wireless LAN as a responder machine to  
perform those tests.  
Another wireless communication tool with 2.4GHz like Bluetooth is interfering  
with the test. Execute this test in the condition where no interference around the  
computer.  
Be sure to turn the wireless communication switch ON before executing  
wireless LAN communication test. (The wireless communication LED lights  
orange.)  
Release the write-protection of floppy disk for the test.  
Setting the responder machine  
To execute subtest 03-07, responder machine with wireless LAN communication function  
(Atheros-made) is required. To set the responder machine, follow the procedures below.  
1. Insert the test program disk to the FDD of responder machine and turn on the power.  
2. Start the program for responder machine automatically.  
3. The program for responder machine is set.  
Setting the tester (DUT) machine  
1. Insert the test program disk 1 to the FDD of tester machine and turn on the power.  
2. The program disk 1 is executed and following message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Atheros MBxx Maintenance T&D (DUT)  
Please exchange for DUT media 2  
*************************************************************  
Please input the “S” key and push the “Enter” key:  
3. Take out the program disk 1 and insert program disk 2. Then, press S and Enter.  
4. Executing program disk 2, following menu will appear in the display. To execute the  
subtest, press test number and Enter.  
3-66  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)  
***********************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Atheros MBxx(MBxxag/xxg) Maintenance T&D Menu  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
1 : SKU check of Module  
2 : MAC Address Check  
3 : Communication test of 11a mode(MBxxag)  
4 : Communication test of 11b mode(MBxxag/MBxxg)  
5 : Communication test of 11g mode(MBxxag/MBxxg)  
6 : All the tests of MBxxg Module  
(SKU & MAC Check, 11b/g communication test)  
*
*
*
*
*
7 : All the tests of MBxxag Module  
(SKU & MAC Check, 11a/b/g communication test)  
***********************************************************  
SELECT TEST No, (1-7):  
Subtest01  
SKU check of module  
This subtest displays SKU information on the wireless LAN card installed.  
Selecting this subtest, following message will appear in the display. Confirm  
if the right information on the wireless LAN card is described.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Module : Atheros MBxxag (RoW)  
G code : xxxxxxxxxxxx  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Using a wrong wireless LAN card (Using unspecified card)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection, execute the subtest again.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest02  
MAC Address Check  
This subtest displays the MAC address. Selecting this subtest, following  
message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
MAC Address Check : OK !!  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Disappearance of MAC address data  
Checking the connection, execute the subtest again.  
Communication test of 11a mode (MBxxag)  
Subtest03  
This subtest checks the connection and communication of wireless LAN  
antenna of Atheros 802.11a mode. Check the packet, throughput and RSSI and  
compare them with the standard.  
After finishing the test, OK message will appear in the display. Press any key  
and return to the test menu.  
When a defective is found during the test, NG message will appear in the  
display. Press any key and following message will appear in the display.  
*************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
11a Communication Test : NG !!  
Please refer to log. txt  
*************************************************************  
Press any key and return to the test menu.  
Open the log file (log.txt) and check the result.  
3-68  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.28 Wireless LAN Test Program (Askey-made)  
When a defective is detected in the test, following typical cause is considered.  
Connection of wireless LAN card  
Connection of wireless LAN antenna cable (Main/Aux)  
Condition of wireless LAN communication (Interference/obstruction)  
Defective wireless LAN card  
Checking the connection and condition, execute the subtest again.  
Communication test of 11b mode (MBxxag/MBxxg)  
Subtest04  
Subtest05  
Subtest06  
This subtest checks the connection and communication of wireless LAN  
antenna of Atheros 802.11b mode.  
For more details on the contents, refer to subtest 03.  
Communication test of 11g mode (MBxxag/MBxxg)  
This subtest checks the connection and communication of wireless LAN  
antenna of Atheros 802.11g mode.  
For more details on the contents, refer to subtest 03.  
All the tests of MBxxg Module  
This subtest checks SKU information, MAC address, connection and  
communication of wireless LAN antenna of Atheros 802.11b mode and  
Atheros 802.11g mode. The test stops at when a defective is found. For more  
details, refer to each subtest.  
Subtest07  
All the tests of MBxxag Module  
This subtest checks SKU information, MAC address, connection and  
communication of wireless LAN antenna of Atheros 802.11a mode, Atheros  
802.11b mode and Atheros 802.11g mode. The test stops at when a defective  
is found. For more details, refer to each subtest.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
This section describes how to perform the LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 test with the  
test program.  
Insert the test program disk for LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 test in FDD and turn on  
the power. The following message will appear:  
Microsoft Windows XX Startup Menu  
----------------------------------  
1. LAN  
2. Modem  
3. Bluetooth  
4. IEEE1394  
Enter a choice:  
Press the number you want to test and press Enter.  
NOTE: It is impossible to go back to startup menu once you choose the test. Therefore,  
LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 test can not be executed successively.  
3.29.1  
LAN test  
To execute LAN test, press 1 and Enter. The following message will appear:  
####################################################################  
######### i82562 ICHx GbE (i82540) Diagnostics program  
#####  
####################################################################  
*
*
* 1 ............ (i82562 + ICHx)  
*
*
*
*
*
* 2 ............ (GbE)  
*
********************************************************************  
.... Press test number[1-2] ?  
Press the number you want to test and press Enter.  
3-70  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
Subtest01  
(i82562 + ICHx)  
This subtest checks the operation of mini-PCI I/F by the loopback test in the  
chip.  
The following message will appear:  
[LAN transmit & receive test !]  
COMPLETED Repeat count =  
Error count =  
00000  
00000  
LOOPBACK TEST  
100Mbps Auto-negotiation TxRx Test  
Destination Address  
Source Address  
= xxxxxxxxxxxx  
= xxxxxxxxxxxx  
** 100Base-TX Full-Duplex **  
< TRANSMIT >  
< RECEIVE >  
NOTE: The menu displayed by your computer may be slightly different from the one  
shown above.  
If a defective is found, NG message will appear in the display.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest02  
(GbE)  
CAUTION: Gigabit Ethernet test is not supported for this model.  
This subtest checks the operation of mini-PCI I/F by the loopback test in the  
chip. Select 2 to execute and press Enter.  
The following message will appear:  
Testing adaptor...hit <ESC> to abort.  
*
External Loopback Test...PASSED  
Testing completed.  
*
*
Loopback Test Complete  
*
*
* 1000Base Auto-negotiation TxRx Test  
*
* CE Test Complete  
NOTE: The menu displayed by your computer may be slightly different from the one  
shown above.  
If a defective is found, NG message will appear in the display.  
3-72  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3.29.2  
Modem test  
For this subtest, connect the modem PCB and RJ11 connector with a harness. Use the  
dedicated “FAT-MODE inspection device (product code: QE2000P01 made by Nitto Denki  
Seisakusyo)” for the tests.  
To execute Modem test, press 2 and Enter. Following message will appear:  
[Modem loopback test !]  
ICHx MDC Test Program with Modem Sound (Line Test)  
Version X.X  
* Scorpio Modem Initialize  
* Digital Loopback Test  
:OK  
:OK  
* RJ11 Connector Check (LED)  
:(Operator’s Check!!)  
NOTE: The menu displayed by your computer may be slightly different from the one  
shown above.  
RJ11 Connection Check (LED) (Operator’s Check LED) test will be executed, and the  
following message will appear:  
...Press Key (Y = OK , N =NG)  
If the color in the LED of the connection checker is orange, press Y, otherwise, press N.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29.3  
Bluetooth test  
CAUTION: Bluetooth test is not supported for this model.  
To execute this test, input 3 and press Enter.  
Note: Use another computer that can communicate by the Bluetooth as a reference  
machine to perform this test.  
Insert a floppy disk containing the test program into the target machine and turn on the target  
machine. The following Bluetooth test menu will appear:  
######################################################################  
####  
Bluetooth sub system test program VX.XX  
####  
######################################################################  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
1....BD_ADDR check  
3... Communications test (DUT mode)  
T....communications test (TEST mode)  
**********************************************************************  
....Press test number [1, 3, T] ? _  
Press 1 or 3 key to perform the corresponding subtest. To quit the Bluetooth test program,  
eject the floppy disk and turn the computer off while the menu above is displayed.  
3-74  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
Subtest01  
BD_ADDR check  
This subtest checks the BD_ADDR functions. When the Bluetooth test menu  
is displayed, press 1 to select the test and press Enter. The following message  
will appear:  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(BD_ADDR) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Initializing …  
When the machine has passed the test, it displays BD_ADDR. If BD_ADDR  
has no problem, the following message is displayed.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(BD_ADDR) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
My BD_ADDR = XXXXXXXXXXXX [h]  
PPPPPP  
A
SSSSS  
SSSSS  
SSSSS  
SSSSS  
P
P
P
A A  
S
S S  
S
S
P A  
A S  
PPPPPP A  
A SSSSS  
AAAAAAA  
P
P
P
S
S
S
A
A
A S  
A SSSSS  
S S  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
If the target machine has any problem, it displays Error CODE. The following  
message is displayed.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(BD_ADDR) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
My BD_ADDR = XXXXXXXXXXXX [h]  
FFFFFF  
A
III  
I
L
F
A A  
L
F
A
A
I
L
FFFFFF A  
A
I
L
F
F
F
AAAAAAA  
I
L
A
A
A
A
I
L
III  
LLLLLLL  
Table 3-5 Error message  
Message  
Contents  
Invalid BD_ADDR (all 00)  
Invalid BD_ADDR (all FF)  
Invalid BD_ADDR (bit0=1)  
Invalid BD_ADDR (bit1=1)  
Invalid BD_ADDR (define in the file)  
0x000000000000  
0xFFFFFFFFFFFF  
bit40=1b  
bit41=1b  
Defined BD_ADDR  
3-76  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
If the machine detects a malfunction, it indicates the error code as shown  
below.  
The error code begins with the least significant digit.  
Error code  
Table 3-6 Error code for Bluetooth test (BD_ADDR) (1/2)  
Error code  
Meaning  
0x01  
0x02  
0x03  
0x04  
0x05  
0x06  
0x07  
0x08  
0x09  
0x0a  
0x0b  
0x0c  
0x0d  
0x0e  
0x0f  
0x10  
0x11  
0x12  
0x13  
0x14  
0x15  
0x16  
0x17  
0x18  
0x19  
0x1a  
0x1b  
0x1c  
0x1d  
0x1e  
0x1f  
Unknown HCI Command.  
No Connection.  
Hardware Failure.  
Page Timeout.  
Authentication Failure.  
Key Missing.  
Memory Full.  
Connection Timeout.  
Max Number Of Connections.  
Max Number Of SCO Connections To A Device.  
ACL Connection already exists.  
Command Disallowed.  
Host Rejected due to limited resources.  
Host Rejected due to security reasons.  
Host Rejected due to remote device is only a personal device.  
Host Timeout.  
Unsupported Feature or Parameter Value.  
Invalid HCI Command Parameters.  
Other End Terminated Connection: Used Ended Connection.  
Other End Terminated Connection: Low Resources.  
Other End Terminated Connection: About to Power Off.  
Connection Terminated by Local Host.  
Repeated Attempts.  
Paring Not Allowed.  
Unknown LMP PDU.  
Unsupported Remote Feature.  
SCO Offset Rejected.  
SCO Interval Rejected.  
SCO Air Mode Rejected.  
Invalid LMP Parameters.  
Unspecified Error.  
** See the Specification of the Bluetooth System for details.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Table 3-6 Error code for Bluetooth test (BD_ADDR) (2/2)  
Error code  
Meaning  
0x20  
0x21  
0x22  
0x23  
0x24  
0x25  
0x26  
0x27  
0x28  
0x29  
0x2a  
0x2b  
0x2c  
0x2d  
0x2e  
0x2f  
Unsupported LMP Parameter Value.  
Role Change Not Allowed.  
LMP Response Timeout.  
LMP Error Transaction Collision.  
LMP PDU Not Allowed.  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
** See the Specification of the Bluetooth System in detail.  
Subtest03  
Communication test (DUT mode)  
This subtest checks the Bluetooth communication functions. Preparing the tester machine for  
the Bluetooth test program. Insert a floppy disk containing the test program into the tester  
machine and turn on the tester machine. The Bluetooth test menu will appear:  
Press 3 to select the test and press Enter in the target machine. The following message will  
appear:  
When the test begins, the machine displays BD_ADDR of the DUT. The progress bar  
stops when the test is completed. The following message is displayed.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(CS-Air) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
+----------------------+  
|
DUT  
|
BD_ADDR of the DUT = XXXXXXXXXXXXX [h]  
+----------------------+  
Ready>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>>  
<- Progress Bar  
[ESC] : Stop  
3-78  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
When the Bluetooth test menu is displayed, press T to select the test and press Enter in the  
test machine. The following message will appear:  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(CS-Air) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
+------------------+  
|
|
|
|
Tester  
|
|
+------------------+  
[ESC]:Finish Tester [SPACE]:Start  
Is DUT ready?  
Then press Space to start the Bluetooth communication test.  
When the machine has passed the test, it displays BD_ADDR of the DUT. If the connection  
with the tester is completed, the progress bar stops. The following message is shown.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(CS-Air) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
+----------------------+  
|
DUT  
|
BD_ADDR of the DUT = XXXXXXXXXXXXX [h]  
+----------------------+  
CCCC  
CCCC  
OOO  
OOO  
M
M PPPPPP L  
EEEEEE TTTTTTT EEEEEEE DDDDD  
C
C
C O  
O MM  
MM P  
P L  
P L  
E
T
E
E
D
D
D
D
C
C
C
O
O
O M M M M P  
E
T
T
T
T
T
D
D
D
O M M M PPPPPP L  
EEEEEE  
EEEEEEE D  
O
O M  
O M  
M
M P  
M P  
M P  
L
L
E
E
E
E
D
D
C O  
LLLLLLL EEEEEE  
EEEEEEE DDDDD  
Testing is finished  
A>_  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
If the target machine has any problem, the following message “INCOMPLETE” is displayed  
with the Error Code.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
Bluetooth Subsystem T&D for PCSE(CS-Air) VerX.XX Copyright (C) by TOSHIBA Co.  
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------  
+----------------------+  
|
DUT  
|
BD_ADDR of the DUT = XXXXXXXXXXXXX [h]  
+----------------------+  
III N  
N
CCCC  
CCCC  
OOO  
OOO  
M
M PPPPPP L  
EEEEEE TTTTTTT EEEEEEE  
I
NN  
N N  
N C  
C O  
O MM  
MM P  
P L  
P L  
E
T
E
I
I
I
I
N C  
O
O
O M M M M P  
E
T
T
T
T
T
E
N N N C  
O M M M PPPPPP L  
EEEEEE  
EEEEEEE  
N
N
N N C  
NN C  
N
O
O M  
O M  
M
M P  
M P  
M P  
L
L
E
E
E
C O  
E
III N  
LLLLLLL EEEEEE  
EEEEEEE  
Testing is finished  
_Press any key to continue. . .  
3-80  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
If the machine detects a malfunction, it indicates the error code as shown below.  
The error code begins with the least significant digit.  
Error code  
Table 3-7 Error code for Bluetooth test (BD_ADDR of the DUT) (1/2)  
Error code  
Meaning  
0x01  
0x02  
0x03  
0x04  
0x05  
0x06  
0x07  
0x08  
0x09  
0x0a  
0x0b  
0x0c  
0x0d  
0x0e  
0x0f  
0x10  
0x11  
0x12  
0x13  
0x14  
0x15  
0x16  
0x17  
0x18  
0x19  
0x1a  
0x1b  
0x1c  
0x1d  
0x1e  
0x1f  
Unknown HCI Command.  
No Connection.  
Hardware Failure.  
Page Timeout.  
Authentication Failure.  
Key Missing.  
Memory Full.  
Connection Timeout.  
Max Number Of Connections.  
Max Number Of SCO Connections To A Device.  
ACL Connection already exists.  
Command Disallowed.  
Host Rejected due to limited resources.  
Host Rejected due to security reasons.  
Host Rejected due to remote device is only a personal device.  
Host Timeout.  
Unsupported Feature or Parameter Value.  
Invalid HCI Command Parameters.  
Other End Terminated Connection: Used Ended Connection.  
Other End Terminated Connection: Low Resources.  
Other End Terminated Connection: About to Power Off.  
Connection Terminated by Local Host.  
Repeated Attempts.  
Paring Not Allowed.  
Unknown LMP PDU.  
Unsupported Remote Feature.  
SCO Offset Rejected.  
SCO Interval Rejected.  
SCO Air Mode Rejected.  
Invalid LMP Parameters.  
Unspecified Error.  
** See the Specification of the Bluetooth System in detail.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Table 3-7 Error code for Bluetooth test (BD_ADDR of the DUT) (2/2)  
Error code  
Meaning  
0x20  
0x21  
0x22  
0x23  
0x24  
0x25  
0x26  
0x27  
0x28  
0x29  
0x2a  
0x2b  
0x2c  
0x2d  
0x2e  
0x2f  
Unsupported LMP Parameter Value.  
Role Change Not Allowed.  
LMP Response Timeout.  
LMP Error Transaction Collision.  
LMP PDU Not Allowed.  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
Not Exist  
** See the Specification of the Bluetooth System in detail.  
3-82  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.29 LAN/Modem/Bluetooth/IEEE1394 Test Program  
3.29.4  
IEEE1394 test  
To execute this test, input 4 and press Enter.  
NOTE:  
Use another computer that can communicate by IEEE1394 (i. Link) cable as a  
reference machine to perform this test.  
The following menu will appear:  
********************************************************************  
********  
IEEE1394[XXXXX] Diagnostics program  
**************  
********************************************************************  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
1 ....(Transmit & Receive test)  
2 ....(Responder set)  
3 ....(1394 GUID Display)  
********************************************************************  
.... Press test number[1-3] ?  
To execute the TEST, select the test number you want to execute and press Enter.  
Subtest01  
Transmit & Receive test  
NOTE:  
Before executing subtest 01, be sure to execute subtest 02 in the responder  
machine.  
This program checks the data transporting between responder machine and  
target machine and compare them with the original data through the  
IEEE1394 cable.  
Subtest02  
Subtest03  
Responder set  
This program is executed in the responder machine to initialize the responder  
machine with the IEEE1394 cable connected to the target machine before  
executing subtest 01.  
IEEE1394 GUID Display  
This program checks the GUID of IEEE1394.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
3-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.30 Sound Test program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3
Tests and Diagnostics  
3.30 Sound Test program  
This section describes how to perform the Sound test. To execute the sound test, refer to the  
following description.  
Insert the test program disk for Sound test in the floppy disk drive and turn on the power. The  
following message will appear:  
################################################################  
######  
WSS, Sound blaster pro Diagnostics program  
######  
################################################################  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
1 ............ Sound (Standard)  
2 ............ Sound (Legacy)  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
3 ............ CD Sound (Standard)  
4 ............ CD Sound (Legacy)  
---It outputs at the speaker and lineout---  
****************************************************************  
.... Press test number[1-4] ?  
Input the test number and press Enter.  
3.30.1 Sound (Standard) test  
To execute the Sound (Standard) test, press 1 and Enter. The following menu will appear in  
the display.  
################################################################  
######  
ICH4-M + AD1981A Diagnostics program  
######  
################################################################  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
1 ............ (Microphone recording & play)  
2 ............ (Sine wave)  
*
*
*
*
*
*
3 ............ (Line IN recording & play)  
9 ............ Exit to Main  
****************************************************************  
.... Press test number[1-3, 9] ?  
3-84  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.30 Sound Test program  
To return to the Sound test menu, Press 9 and Enter. Then following message will appear in  
the display.  
***********************************  
******** May I Restart ? *******  
***********************************  
Press any key to continue…  
After pressing any key, the machine starts rebooting and sound test menu will appear in the  
display.  
Subtest01  
Microphone recording & play  
This subtest checks the function of the CODEC A/D, D/A converter.  
When this subtest is selected, the following message will appear.  
[Recording & play test !]  
And the following message will appear.  
DOS/4GW Protected Mode Run-time Version X.XX  
Copyright (c) Tenberry Software, Inc. XXXX  
After this message appears, display stops briefly. In this timing, sound is  
recorded from internal microphone.  
After the recording is completed, the computer plays back the sound recorded  
after the following message.  
STACWAVE Version X.XX  
Build data: XXX XX XXXX at XX:XX:XX  
Loading “mic.wav”.  
NOTE:  
The message in the display might have slight difference from those above.  
The display returns to the Sound (Standard) test menu after the test ends.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.30 Sound Test program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest02  
Sine Wave  
This subtest is executed by loading the COM file (ADSIN.COM). The  
program expands sine wave data table from 16KB to 64KB, and creates the  
play data. Then it transfers the data between the DMA and the CODEC to  
play the sine wave. (It sounds like a continuous beep). By using wave  
measurable devices such as an oscilloscope, the data can be measured as a  
sine wave.  
When the subtest is executed, the sine wave is played while expanding sine  
wave from 16KB to 64KB.  
The display returns to the Sound (Standard) test menu after the test ends.  
Line IN recording & play  
Subtest03  
This subtest executes the same test as the subtest01 by recorded sound from  
the different port (Line-in port).  
For more details on the subtest, refer to the subtest01 Microphone recording &  
play.  
The display returns to the Sound (Standard) test menu after the test ends.  
3.30.2 Sound (Legacy) test  
To execute the Sound (Legacy) test, select 2 and press Enter.  
CAUTION: Sound (Legacy) test is not supported in this model.  
3-86  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.30 Sound Test program  
3.30.3 CD Sound (Standard) test  
To execute the CD Sound (Standard) test, press 3 and Enter. Insert the test media  
(TOSHIBA TEST CD-ROM or ABEX TEST CD-ROM) or music CD on the market (if the  
test media can not be prepared). Following menu appears in the display.  
For details on use of test media, refer to (1) Test media (Toshiba-made test media).  
For details on use of audio CD on the market, refer to (2) Audio CD.  
(1) Test media (Toshiba-made test media)  
xxxxxxx DIAGNOSTIC TEST VX.XX  
[Ctrl]+[Break] ; test end  
CD/DVD TEST IN PROGRESS XXXXXXXX  
[Ctrl]+[C]  
; key stop  
SUB-TEST : XX  
PASS COUNT : XXXXX  
WRITE DATA : XX  
ERROR COUNT: XXXXX  
READ DATA : XX  
STATUS : XXX  
ADDRESS  
: XXXXXX  
01 – Japanese Narration  
02 – English Narration  
03 – Test Tone A (100Hz – 20Hz)  
04 - Test Tone B (400Hz – 3KHz L-R)  
Drive # = 0, ATAPI status =00  
Command = XX  
[[Block address = XXXXXXXX]]  
[[Block length = XXXXXXXX]]  
Final : Block address = XXXXXXXXX  
Subtest01  
Japanese Narration  
Selected this subtest, narration in Japanese starts and following message  
appears in the display.  
Play start CD sound !  
Press any key <Play stop>.  
Press any key and stop the narration. Then return to the CD Sound (Standard)  
test menu.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.30 Sound Test program  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Subtest02  
English Narration  
Selected this subtest, narration in English starts.  
For more details on the procedure, refer to the subtest01.  
Test Tone A  
Subtest03  
Caution: Before starting subtest03, be sure to set the sound at proper volume.  
This subtest plays sine wave while changing its table from 100Hz to 20Hz.  
Return to the CD Sound (Standard) menu after the test ends.  
Subtest 04  
Test Tone B  
This subtest plays sine wave while changing its table from 400Hz to 3KHz  
and also changing the channel from left speaker to right speaker.  
Return to the CD Sound (Standard) menu after the test ends.  
3-88  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.30 Sound Test program  
(2) Audio CD  
Insert an audio CD and the following menu appears in the display.  
xxxxxxx DIAGNOSTIC TEST VX.XX  
[Ctrl]+[Break] ; test end  
CD/DVD TEST IN PROGRESS XXXXXXXX  
[Ctrl]+[C]  
; key stop  
SUB-TEST : XX  
PASS COUNT : XXXXX  
WRITE DATA : XX  
ERROR COUNT: XXXXX  
READ DATA : XX  
STATUS : XXX  
ADDRESS  
: XXXXXX  
CD Sound track number (01-98 : Track) ?  
Drive # = 0, ATAPI status =00  
Command = XX  
[[Block address = XXXXXXXX]]  
[[Block length = XXXXXXXX]]  
Final : Block address = XXXXXXXXX  
Select the track number you want to test and press Enter twice.  
The following message appears in the display and selected track is played.  
Play start CD sound !  
Press any key <play stop>  
After pressing any key, the music stops and the display returns to the selection menu of the  
track number.  
NOTE:  
When the CD-ROM test is executed, [ALL DEVICE] must be selected in the  
“Device Config.=” of the BIOS SETUP. If the “ALL DEVICE” is not selected,  
music can not be played.  
3.30.4 CD Sound (Legacy) test  
To execute the CD Sound (Legacy) test, select 4 and press Enter.  
CAUTION: Sound (Legacy) test is not supported in this model.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
3.31.1 Function Description  
This program displays the current system setup information as listed below:  
1. Memory  
2. System Date/Time  
3. Battery  
(a) Battery Save Mode  
(b) PCI Express Link ASPM  
4. Password  
5. HDD Password  
(a) HDD  
(b) HDD Password Mode  
(c) User Password  
(d) Master Password  
6. Boot Priority  
(a) Boot Priority  
(b) HDD Priority  
(c) Network Boot Protocol  
7. Display  
(a) Power On Display  
(b) LCD Display Stretch  
(c) TV Type  
8. Others  
(a) Dynamic CPU Frequency Mode  
(b) Execute-Disable Bit Capability  
(c) Auto Power On  
(d) Diagnostic Mode  
(e) Language During Bootup  
9. Configuration  
10. I/O Ports  
(a) Serial  
(b) Parallel  
3-90  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
11. Drives I/O  
(a) Built-in HDD  
(b) CD-ROM  
12. PCI Bus  
13. Security Controller  
(a) TPM  
(b) Clear TPM Owner  
14. Peripheral  
(a) Internal Pointing Device  
(b) Ext Keyboard “Fn”  
(c) Parallel Port Mode  
15. Legacy Emulation  
(a) USB KB/Mouse Legacy Emulation  
(b) USB-FDD Legacy Emulation  
(c) USB Memory BIOS Support Type  
16. PCI LAN  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31.2 Accessing the SETUP Program  
Selecting 0 from the DIAGNOSTICS MENU and pressing Enter displays the followings:  
3-92  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
NOTE:  
*1. HDD PASSWORD window shows slightly different display for each model.  
*2. LCD Display Streatch is displayed only for the model with XGA panel.  
*3. Dynamic CPU Frequency Mode is displayed only for the model with  
Pentium-M processor.  
*4. Language During Bootup is displayed only for the model for TCL  
(Canada).  
*5. I/O PORTS window shows slightly different display for each model.  
*6. SECURITY CONTROLLER window is displayed only for the model with  
TPM function when the SETUP is operated during IRT.  
*7. Ext Keyboard “Fn” is displayed only for the model supporting its  
functuion.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
Moving Within the SETUP Menu and Changing Values  
1. Press Å and Æ to move between the two columns. Press and to move between  
items in a column. Press Fn+↑ (PgUp) and Fn + ↓ (PgDn) to move between the  
two pages.  
2. Press either the Space bar or Back Space to change the value.  
Accepting Changes and Exiting the SETUP Window  
1. Press End to accept the changes you made.  
If the changed item does not require the system to reboot, the following message is  
displayed:  
Are you sure? (Y/N)  
If the changed item requires the system to reboot, the following message is displayed:  
Are you sure? (Y/N)  
The changes you made will cause the system to reboot.  
2. To make other changes, press N. Repeat the steps above.  
3. To accept the changes, press Y.  
NOTE: You can press Esc to quit at any time without saving changes. SETUP asks you  
to confirm that you do not want to save your changes. When SETUP is displayed  
at the next time, the current configuration appears.  
The Factory Preset Configuration  
When you access SETUP, the current configuration is displayed.  
1. To show the factory preset configuration, press Home.  
2. To accept the default settings, press End and then press Y.  
NOTE: When you execute the default setting, the following settings are not changed:  
(1) HDD Mode  
(2) Password  
(3) Write Policy  
3-94  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
SETUP Options  
The SETUP screen is divided into 14 functionally related groups. This section describes each  
group and its options.  
1. Memory  
This group of options displays the computer’s memory.  
This field displays the total amount of memory installed and is automatically  
calculated by the computer. You cannot change this value.  
2. System Date/Time  
Sets the date and time.  
System Date  
System Time  
Sets date.  
Sets time.  
3. Battery  
(a) Battery Save Mode  
This option is used to select Full Power, Low Power or User Setting of the battery  
save mode. When you select the battery save mode, the followings will appear.  
Full Power  
The following shows full power settings.  
Low Power  
The following shows low power settings.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
NOTE: Display of the LCD Brightness will be changed in the condition below:  
(*1) Operating the battery  
(*2) Using the AC adapter  
User Setting  
Use this option to set the battery save parameters on  
the sub-window, BATTERY SAVE OPTIONS.  
Battery Save Options  
Processing Speed  
This feature changes the CPU processing speed.  
High  
Low  
CPU operates at 1.60/1.73/1.87/2.00/2.13GHz(Pentium-M),  
(Default in Full Power Mode)  
CPU operates at half processing speed.  
(Default in Low Power Mode)  
CPU Sleep Mode  
Use this option to enable or disable the CPU sleep function.  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Enables sleep mode. (Default)  
Disables sleep mode.  
LCD Brightness  
Use this option to set the level of LCD brightness.  
Super-Bright  
Bright  
Full brightness for maximum visibility.  
Full brightness for high visibility.  
Semi-Bright  
Less than full brightness for saving power.  
Cooling Method  
Maximum Performance  
If the CPU becomes too hot, the fan turns on  
automatically in a high speed to cool down the  
CPU.  
Performance  
If the CPU becomes too hot, the fan turns on  
automatically. When the CPU temperature falls  
to a normal range, the fan turns off.  
3-96  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
Battery optimized  
If the CPU becomes too hot, the processing  
speed is lowered. If the temperature is still too  
high, the fan turns on. When the CPU  
temperature falls to a normal range, the fan is  
turned off and the processing speed is increased.  
NOTE: Too hot condition may cause defect on the CPU. When the hot condition  
continues, the power is automatically turned off in resume mode.  
(b) PCI Express Link ASPM  
This option set the power-saving function of PCI Express on the following  
conditions.  
Auto  
PCI Express devices are not used while battery  
operation. (Default)  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Disable the Power-saving function and drive  
with maximum performance.  
PCI Express devices are not used.  
4. Password  
This option sets or resets the user password for power on and instant security  
(Fn+F1).  
Registered  
The user password has been registered.  
The user password has not been registered.  
Not registered  
For details on setting the user password, refer to the User’s Manual.  
(a) User Password  
Sets the User HDD Password.  
For details, refer to the User’s Manual.  
(b) Master Password  
Sets the Master HDD Password. This can be set when Master+User is set in  
the HDD password Mode. For details, refer to the User’s Manual.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
5. HDD Password  
This option registers, resets or changes the HDD password.  
(a) HDD  
Hard disk for setting the password.  
Built-in HDD  
The password is set to Built-in HDD. (This cannot be  
changed.)  
(b) HDD Password Mode  
This item registers HDD password and can be selected only for registering  
HDD password. To change HDD Password Mode when HDD password is  
registered, delete the registered HDD password first, and then register new  
password.  
User Only  
Sets only User HDD Password (Default)  
Master+User  
Sets Master HDD Password and User HDD Password  
(c) User Password  
This item sets User password.  
For details on setting user password, refer to the User’s Manual.  
(d) Master Password  
This item sets the Master HDD password.  
This can be set, only when Master+User is set in the HDD password Mode.  
For details, refer to the User’s Manual.  
6. Boot Priority  
(a) Boot Priority  
Use this option to set the priority for booting of the computer and the priority  
for the HDD for booting.  
FDDHDDCD-ROMLAN: The computer looks for bootable files in  
the following order: FDD, HDD, CD-  
ROM (*1) and LAN  
HDDCD-ROMLANFDD: The computer looks for bootable files in  
the following order: HDD, CD-ROM,  
LAN and FDD.  
FDDCD-ROMLANHDD: The computer looks for bootable files in  
the following order: FDD, CD-ROM,  
LAN and HDD.  
CD-ROMLANHDDFDD: The computer looks for bootable files in  
the following order: CD-ROM, LAN,  
HDD and FDD.  
3-98  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
CD-ROMLANFDDHDD: The computer looks for bootable files in  
the following order: CD-ROM, LAN,  
FDD and HDD.  
HDDFDDCD-ROMLAN: The computer looks for bootable files in  
the following order: HDD, FDD, CD-  
ROM and LAN. (Default)  
(*1) CD-ROM refers to a Optical Disk Drive.  
(b) HDD Priority  
Use this option to set the booting priority from HDD.  
Built in HDDUSB (Default)  
: detecting boot-command from Built in HDD  
USB Built in HDD  
: detecting boot-command from USB memory  
(c) Network Boot Protocol  
Use this option to set the starting method via a network.  
PXE Sets to PXE protocol. (Default)  
RPL Sets to RPL protocol.  
7. Display  
This group of options configures the computer’s display.  
(a) Power On Display  
This option is used to select the display when booting up.  
Auto-Selected  
Selects an external monitor if one is connected.  
Otherwise it selects the internal LCD. (Default)  
LCD+AnalogRGB Selects both the internal LCD and the external CRT for  
simultaneous display.  
NOTE: When starting the computer in Standby or Hibernation, the last configuration is  
remembered. If data does not appear on the display you are using after starting  
in Standby or Hibernation, pressing Fn+F5.  
Pressing Fn+F5 changes the display setting as follows in order: the internal  
LCD, the external display, both the internal LCD and the external display.  
When an external display, which does not support SVGA mode is connected and  
“LCD+AnalogRGB” is selected, the external display is not displayed.  
(b) LCD Display Stretch  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
LCD Display Stretch enables or disables a larger display area of the screen.  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Enables the LCD display stretch feature. (Default)  
Disables the LCD display stretch feature.  
(c) TV Type  
This option allows you to select the type of TV.  
NTSC (Japan)  
TV in Japanese system  
NTSC (US)  
TV in the U.S. system  
PAL (S-Video)  
525p (480p,D2)  
750p (720p,D4)  
1125i (1080i,D3)  
525i (480i,D1)  
PAL (SCART)  
TV in Europe and China system  
High Definition Television with 480 progressive scan  
High Definition Television with 720 progressive scan  
High Definition Television with 1080 interlace  
High Definition Television with 480 interlace  
TV in Europe system  
8. Others  
Whether or not you need to configure the computer with these options depends  
primarily on the kind of software or peripherals you use.  
(a) Dynamic CPU Frequency mode  
Use this option to choose a setting from the followings.  
Dynamically Switchable  
Enables Pentium-M processor featuring Intel SpeedStep  
technology. (Default)  
Always High  
Always Low  
Disables Pentium-M processor featuring Intel  
SpeedStep technology and always runs the processor at  
its maximum speed.  
Disables Pentium-M processor featuring Intel  
SpeedStep technology and always runs the processor at  
its default speed.  
(b) Execute-Disable Bit Capability  
This option set the Execute-Disable Bit function of CPU to the operation  
system. Execute-Disable Bit gives higher security function preventing the PC  
from the computer viruses and buffer overflow problem on unauthorized  
access.  
3-100  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
Available  
Enable the Execute-Disable Bit function.  
Disable the Execute-Disable Bit function.  
Not Available  
(c) Auto Power On  
This option displays setting for Auto Power On.  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Indicates auto power on is not set.  
Indicates auto power on is set.  
When “Enabled” is selected, the following sub-window appears.  
OPTIONS  
Alarm Time  
Alarm Date Option  
= 00:00:00  
= Disabled  
Set the parameters for the Auto Power On (automatic power on) function in  
the “OPTIONS” window. To set the time, use Space or BackSpace. Press  
to move the cursor to the right and to move the cursor to the left when  
you set the date and time.  
For the Alarm Time, set the time to turn on the power automatically. The  
“second” cannot be set. When it is set to “Disabled”, the time to turn on  
automatically is not set.  
For the Alarm Date Option, set the date to turn on the power automatically.  
When it is set to “Disabled”, the time to turn on automatically is not set.  
NOTE: 1. Do not remove the AC adaptor and battery pack at the same time when you  
use this feature. If you do so, data saved by the resume function will be lost.  
You must also reset this option.  
2. If you have set a password and the computer boots by the Auto Power On  
function and Standby is on, the computer will start with the instant security  
function enabled. The password = message is not displayed; however, you  
must enter the password to use the computer.  
3. This option is enabled only once, the setting is reset, after booting up.  
(d) Diagnostic Mode  
This option enables/disables the HW Diagnostic test function.  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Disables the HW Diagnostic test function. (Default)  
Enables the HW Diagnostic test function.  
(e) Language During Bootup  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
This option selects the language during bootup. This message appears only on  
the model for TCL (Canada).  
English  
French  
Message is displayed in English. (Default)  
Message is displayed in French.  
9. Configuration  
This option lets you set the device configuration.  
All Devices  
BIOS sets all devices.  
Setup by OS  
Initializes devices, which is needed to load an operating  
system. Operating system initializes other devices.  
NOTE: (1) When using installed OS, selecting “Setup by OS” is recommended.  
(2) When executing test programs, be sure to select “ALL Device”. And after  
the test end, select “Setup by OS”.  
3-102  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
10. I/O ports  
This option controls settings for the serial and parallel ports.  
(a) Serial  
Use this option to set the COM level for the serial port. The serial port  
interrupt request level (IRQ) and I/O port base address for each COM level is  
shown below:  
COM level  
COM1  
Interrupt level  
I/O address  
3F8H  
4
3
4
5
7
3
5
7
(Default)  
COM2  
2F8H  
COM3  
3E8H  
COM3  
3E8H  
COM3  
3E8H  
COM4  
2E8H  
COM4  
2E8H  
COM4  
2E8H  
Not Used  
Disables port  
(b) Parallel  
This option sets the interrupt request level and I/O port base address for the  
parallel port. When the parallel port mode is set to Std. Bi-direct, the options  
are as follows:  
LPT setting  
LPT 1  
Interrupt level  
I/O address  
378H  
7
5
7
LPT 2  
278H  
LPT 3  
3BCH  
Not Used  
Disables port  
When the parallel port mode (see settings below) is set to ECP, the DMA  
channel can also be set to 1 or 3. The default is 3.  
LPT setting  
LPT 1  
Interrupt level  
I/O address  
378H  
DMA channel  
7
5
7
3 (Default)  
LPT 2  
278H  
3
3
LPT 3  
3BCH  
Not Used  
Disables port  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
When you select one of the above options, except for Not Used, a subwindow  
similar to the one below appears to let you set the DMA. The options for this  
setting are Channel 1and Channel 3 (Default).  
OPTIONS  
DMA  
= Channel 3 (Default)  
For most printers, the port should be set to ECP. With some other parallel  
devices, the setting should be Std. Bi-Direct.  
11. Drives I/O  
This option displays the address and interrupts level for hard disk drive and optical  
disk drive. It is for information only and cannot be changed.  
Built-in HDD  
CD-ROM  
This cannot be changed.  
This cannot be changed.  
12. PCI Bus  
This option displays the interrupt level for the Card Bus in the computer. It is for  
information only and cannot be changed.  
PCI BUS  
= IRQ10, IRQ11  
13. Security controller  
(a) TPM  
Disables the security controller called TPM (Trusted Platform Module).  
When the cursor is on the Enable (Disable) and the Space is pressed,  
message is displayed and the PC waits Y or N key input by the user.  
When Y is pressed, it is sets to Enable (Disable). After changing, the cursor  
could not be moved on the TPM tem. This option can be changed after  
rebooting.  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Disables the TPM. (Default)  
Enables the TPM.  
(b) Clear TPM Owner  
This is not displayed when the TPM is set to Disabled. This is executed,  
when the PC is disposed or the owner of the PC changes.  
When the cursor is on this item and the Space is pressed, message is  
displayed and the PC waits Y, E, S and Enter key inputs by the user.  
When Y, E, S and Enter keys are pressed, the data is disposed.  
After changing, the display of TPM item is changed to Disabled and this item  
becomes not displayed and the cursor could not be moved on the TPM item.  
3-104  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
3.31 SETUP  
14. Peripheral  
Use this option to select the peripheral's mode.  
(a) Internal Pointing Device  
This option enables or disables the touch pad  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Enables the touch pad. (Default)  
Disables the touch pad.  
(b) Ext Keyboard "Fn"  
This option enables or disables Fn key function on the external keyboard.  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Enables the feature.  
Disables the feature. (Default)  
When “Enabled” is selected, the following sub-window appears.  
KEYBOARD  
Ext Keyboard "Fn" key equivalent  
= Left Ctrl + Left Alt  
Use this option to set a key combination on an external keyboard to emulate  
the Fn key on the computer's internal keyboard. Setting a Fn key equivalent  
will enable you to use “Hotkeys” by pressing the set combination in place of  
the Fn key. The following items can be selected for this option:  
= Left Ctrl + Left Alt (*1)  
= Right Ctrl + Right Alt (*2)  
= Left Alt + Left Shift  
= Right Alt + Right Shift  
= Left Alt + Caps Lock  
NOTE: If these selections ((*1) or (*2)) are made, you cannot warm boot the  
system by pressing Ctrl + Alt + Del.  
(c) Parallel Port Mode  
Use this option to set information of Parallel Port Mode.  
ECP  
Sets the port mode to Extended Capabilities Port (ECP).  
For most printers, the port should be set to ECP. (Default)  
Std. Bi-Direct.  
Sets the bi-directional setting. This setting should be used  
with some other parallel devices.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL] 3-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3.31 SETUP  
3 Tests and Diagnostics  
NOTE: When using Windows, the setting of “Toshiba HW setup” is enabled and the  
setting of “Parallel Port Mode” is disabled.  
15. LEGACY EMULATION  
(a) USB KB/Mouse Legacy Emulation  
This option sets the Legacy support condition of the USB keyboard and the USB  
mouse.  
Enabled  
Enables LEGACY support. (Default)  
USB keyboard/USB mouse are available without the driver.  
Disabled  
Disables LEGACY support  
(b) USB-FDD Legacy Emulation  
This option sets the Legacy support condition of the USB floppy disk drive.  
When a computer is FDD built-in model, this option is not displayed.  
Enabled  
Enables LEGACY support. (Default)  
USB floppy disk is available without the driver.  
Disabled  
Disables LEGACY support  
(c) USB Memory BIOS support Type  
This option sets the priority of the USB memory as a startup device.  
HDD  
Sets the priority of the USB memory to be equivalent to the HDD.  
(Default)  
FDD  
Sets the priority of the USB memory to be equivalent to the FDD.  
16. PCI LAN  
This option sets the Enable / Disable of the built-in LAN functions.  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Enables built-in LAN functions. (Default)  
Disables built-in LAN functions.  
3-106  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4  
Replacement Procedures  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4
4-ii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Chapter 4  
Contents  
4.1  
Overview.................................................................................................................... 4-1  
Safety Precautions................................................................................................ 4-2  
Before You Begin ................................................................................................ 4-3  
Disassembly Procedures ...................................................................................... 4-4  
Assembly Procedures........................................................................................... 4-5  
Tools and Equipment........................................................................................... 4-5  
Screw Tightening Torque .................................................................................... 4-6  
Grip Color............................................................................................................ 4-6  
Screw Notation..................................................................................................... 4-7  
Battery Pack/PC Card ................................................................................................ 4-8  
4.2.1 Battery Pack............................................................................................... 4-8  
4.2.2 PC Card.................................................................................................... 4-10  
Memory Module ...................................................................................................... 4-11  
MDC ........................................................................................................................ 4-14  
HDD......................................................................................................................... 4-16  
Wireless LAN Card.................................................................................................. 4-19  
Cooling Fin/CPU ..................................................................................................... 4-21  
Keyboard.................................................................................................................. 4-26  
Switch Membrane Board ......................................................................................... 4-30  
4.2  
4.3  
4.4  
4.5  
4.6  
4.7  
4.8  
4.9  
4.10 Optical Drive............................................................................................................ 4-32  
4.11 Display Assembly.................................................................................................... 4-34  
4.12 Sound Board............................................................................................................. 4-38  
4.13 Parallel port board/Serial port board/S-Video board ............................................... 4-39  
4.14 FAN.......................................................................................................................... 4-46  
4.15 System Board/DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery................................................................. 4-47  
4.16 PC card cover........................................................................................................... 4-50  
4.17 Battery Latch............................................................................................................ 4-51  
4.18 Battery Lock............................................................................................................. 4-53  
4.19 Touch Pad ............................................................................................................... 4-55  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter.............................................................................................. 4-57  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.21 Latch Assembly ....................................................................................................... 4-61  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge................................................................... 4-62  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp..................................................................................................... 4-71  
4.23.1 Replacing the 15.0 Inch XGA Samsung Fluorescent Lamp ................. 4-72  
4.23.2 Replacing the 15.0 Inch XGA Sharp Fluorescent Lamp ....................... 4-81  
4.23.3 Replacing the 15.0 Inch XGA LG.Philips Fluorescent Lamp ............... 4-98  
4.23.4 Replacing the 15.0 Inch SXGA+ LG.Philips Fluorescent Lamp......... 4-105  
4-iv  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Figures  
Figure 4-1 Removing Battery Pack....................................................................................... 4-8  
Figure 4-2 Removing PC Card ........................................................................................... 4-10  
Figure 4-3 Removing Memory Slot Cover......................................................................... 4-11  
Figure 4-4 Removing Memory Module.............................................................................. 4-12  
Figure 4-5 Removing MDC................................................................................................ 4-14  
Figure 4-6 Removing HDD Slot Cover .............................................................................. 4-16  
Figure 4-7 Removing HDD ASSY ..................................................................................... 4-17  
Figure 4-8 Removing HDD ................................................................................................ 4-17  
Figure 4-9 Removing Mini PCI Slot Cover........................................................................ 4-18  
Figure 4-10 Removing wireless LAN Card........................................................................ 4-20  
Figure 4-11 Removing CPU Cover..................................................................................... 4-21  
Figure 4-12 Removing CPU Holder ................................................................................... 4-22  
Figure 4-13 Removing Cooling Fin.................................................................................... 4-23  
Figure 4-14 Removing CPU ............................................................................................... 4-23  
Figure 4-15 Installing CPU................................................................................................. 4-24  
Figure 4-16 Applying Silicon Grease ................................................................................. 4-25  
Figure 4-17 Removing Keyboard Holder ........................................................................... 4-26  
Figure 4-18 Removing Keyboard ....................................................................................... 4-27  
Figure 4-19 Removing Keyboard Support Plate.................................................................. 4-28  
Figure 4-20 Removing Switch membrane Board ................................................................ 4-30  
Figure 4-21 Removing optical ............................................................................................. 4-32  
Figure 4-22 Removing bracket ............................................................................................ 4-33  
Figure 4-23 Removing screws on the bottom..................................................................... 4-34  
Figure 4-24 Removing screws and cables .......................................................................... 4-35  
Figure 4-25 Removing Display Assembly.......................................................................... 4-36  
Figure 4-26 Removing Sound Board.................................................................................. 4-38  
Figure 4-27 Removing Harness Holder.............................................................................. 4-39  
Figure 4-28 Removing parallel port board.......................................................................... 4-40  
Figure 4-29 Removing serial port board............................................................................. 4-42  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-v  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Figure 4-30 Removing S-Video board................................................................................ 4-44  
Figure 4-31 Removing Fan................................................................................................. 4-40  
Figure 4-32 Opening Insulators .......................................................................................... 4-46  
Figure 4-33 Removing System Board................................................................................. 4-47  
Figure 4-34 Removing PC card cover ................................................................................ 4-50  
Figure 4-35 Removing SB Latch Button ............................................................................. 4-51  
Figure 4-36 Removing Battery Lock L............................................................................... 4-51  
Figure 4-37 Removing Battery Lock Button ....................................................................... 4-53  
Figure 4-38 Removing Battery Lock R .............................................................................. 4-53  
Figure 4-39 Removing Touch Pad ..................................................................................... 4-55  
Figure 4-40 Removing Display Mask................................................................................. 4-57  
Figure 4-41 Removing FL Inverter and LCD Unit............................................................. 4-58  
Figure 4-42 Removing LCD Bracket.................................................................................. 4-59  
Figure 4-43 Removing Latch Assembly............................................................................. 4-61  
Figure 4-44 Removing Wireless LAN Antennas................................................................ 4-63  
Figure 4-45 Removing LCD harness Holder....................................................................... 4-64  
Figure 4-46 Removing Display Cover................................................................................ 4-64  
Figure 4-47 Removing Hinge Cap...................................................................................... 4-64  
Figure 4-48 Removing Optical Drive Cover ....................................................................... 4-66  
Figure 4-49 Removing Speaker Cables .............................................................................. 4-67  
Figure 4-50 Removing Speakers......................................................................................... 4-68  
Figure 4-51 Removing Hinges............................................................................................ 4-68  
Figure 4-52 Attaching sponges........................................................................................... 4-69  
Figure 4-53 to 4-100 Replacing Fluorescent Lamp...............................................4-72 to 4-113  
4-vi  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.1 Overview  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4
4.1 Overview  
This chapter describes the procedure for removing and replacing the field replaceable units  
(FRUs) in the PC. It may not be necessary to remove all the FRUs in order to replace one.  
The chart below provides a guide as to which other FRUs must be removed before a  
particular FRU can be removed. The numbers in the chart indicate the relevant section  
numbers in this manual.  
In all cases when removing an FRU, the battery pack must also be removed. When repairing  
an FRU that is the potential cause of a computer fault, use the chart to determine the order in  
which FRUs need to be removed.  
4.2.2  
PC  
4.2.1 Battery Pack  
Card  
4.5  
HDD  
4.6  
Wireless  
LAN  
4.7  
Cooling Fin  
/CPU  
4.3  
Memory  
Module  
4.8 Keyboard  
4.20  
LCD unit/  
FL inverter  
4.10  
Optical  
Drive  
4.9  
Card  
Membrane  
Switch  
Board  
4.4 MDC  
4.11 Display Assembly  
4.12  
Sound Board  
4.13  
4.14  
FAN  
4.19  
Touch Pad  
4.21  
Latch  
Assembly  
4.22  
Exclusive  
Selectable  
Board  
Wireless LAN Antenna  
/Speaker/Hinge  
4.15 System Board/ DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery  
4.17 Battery Latch  
4.18 Battery Lock  
4.16  
PC Card Cover  
4.2.2  
PC  
4.2.1 Battery Pack  
Chart Notation  
Card  
The chart shows the case for the  
following example;  
4.5  
4.6  
4.7  
Cooling Fin  
/CPU  
4.3  
Memory  
Module  
4.8 Keyboard  
4.20  
LCD unit/  
FL Inverter  
HDD Wireless  
LAN  
Card  
4.10  
Membrane Optical  
4.9  
* Removing System Board  
4.4 MDC  
Switch  
Board  
Drive  
All FRUs down to the “4.2.1  
Battery Pack” to “4.14 FAN”  
units must be removed to remove  
the system board.  
4.11 Display Aassembly  
4.12  
Sound Board  
4.13  
4.14  
FAN  
4.19  
Touch  
Pad  
4.21  
Latch  
Assembly  
Exclusive  
Selectable Board  
4.22  
Wireless LAN  
Antenna  
/Speaker/Hinge  
4.15 System Board/ DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery  
4.17 Battery Latch  
4.18 Battery Lock  
4.16  
PC Card Cover  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.1 Overview  
Safety Precautions  
Please read the following safety instructions before disassembling the computer and always  
follow the instructions while working on the computer.  
Danger: 1. In the case of the battery, always use authentic parts or equivalent parts  
approved by Toshiba. Other batteries may have different specifications that  
are incompatible with the computer and may result in fire or explosion.  
Due to the risk of alkali fluid leaks, never attempt to heat or disassemble the  
battery. Similarly, due to the risk of explosion, never expose the battery to  
flame.  
2. Some parts including the power supply and FL inverter generate high  
voltages. If you need to turn on the power while disassembling the computer,  
do not touch any connectors or other components due to the risk of electric  
shock. Also, do not disassemble individual parts when performing routine  
maintenance.  
Warning:1. To prevent electric shock, turn off the power unplug the AC adapter from the  
power source.  
2. As the battery installed to the computer is typically already charged, the risk  
of electric shock remains even when the AC adapter is unplugged from the  
socket. To prevent electric shock, always take off any metal jewelry or  
accessories such as necklaces, bracelets or rings before working on the  
computer. Never work with wet or moist hands.  
3. Take care not to injury yourself on any edges or corners.  
Caution:1. Confirm that replacement parts have compatible specifications before  
replacing on the computer. Never use incorrect parts as these may cause  
faults on the computer.  
2. To prevent internal damage such as short circuits or burning, do not allow any  
screws, paper clips, or other metal objects to fall into the computer. When  
removing screws, always replace with the same size screw. Ensure that all  
screws are fully tightened. Loose screws may result in short circuits leading to  
overheating, smoke or flame.  
3. To prevent electric shock, check that you have disconnected all cables from a  
part before removing the part.  
4. When connecting to the AC power supply, use only an AC adapter and cable  
approved by Toshiba.  
5. To prevent electric shock, ensure that all replacement parts are compatible  
with the computer and that all cables and connectors are securely connected.  
4-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.1 Overview  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Before You Begin  
Take note of the following points before starting work. Always remove the AC adapter and  
battery pack before commencing any of the procedures. The procedure for removing the  
battery pack is described in section “4.2.1 Battery Pack”.  
1. Do not disassemble the computer unless it is operating abnormally.  
2. Use the designated tools.  
3. Ensure that the environment for working on and storing parts does not contain any of  
the following.  
Dust or dirt  
Static electricity  
Extremely hot, cold, or humid conditions  
4. Perform the diagnostic tests described in Chapter 2 to determine which FRU is the  
cause of the fault.  
5. Do not perform any unnecessary work. Always work in accordance with the  
disassembly and reassembly procedures in this manual.  
6. Keep parts removed from the computer in a safe place away from the computer where  
they will not be damaged or interfere with your work.  
7. Disassembling requires the removal of a large number of screws. Keep removed  
screws in a safe place such that you can determine which screws belong to which part.  
8. When reassembling, ensure that you use the correct screws and fit parts in the correct  
position. Screw sizes are noted in the text and figures.  
9. As all parts have sharp edges and corners, take care not to cut yourself.  
10. After replacing an FRU, check that the computer and replaced part operate correctly.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.1 Overview  
Disassembly Procedures  
Three main types of cable connector are used.  
Pressure plate connector  
Spring connector  
Normal pin connector  
When disconnecting a pressure plate connector, lift up the tag on one side of the plastic  
pressure plate on the connector and pull the cable out from the connector. When reconnecting  
a cable to a pressure plate connector, lift up the pressure plate to a suitable height and insert  
the cable into the connector. Press down on both sides of the pressure plate such that both  
sides of the plate and connector are at the same height and that the cable is fixed in the  
correct position. Pull the cable to ensure that it is securely connected. If the cable is  
disconnected from the connector, reconnect it making sure that you lift the pressure plate  
high enough to insert fully the cable.  
For spring connectors, lifting up the stopper frees the cable and allows it to be pulled out. To  
reconnect, hold the stopper in the up position and insert the cable, then lower the stopper to  
secure the cable.  
Normal pin connectors are used for all other cables. Simply pull out or push in these  
connectors to disconnect or reconnect.  
4-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.1 Overview  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Assembly Procedure  
After the computer has been disassembled and the part that caused the fault has been repaired  
or replaced, the computer must be reassembled.  
Take note of the following general points when assembling the computer.  
Take your time and follow the instructions carefully. Hurrying the assembly work  
will only introduce new problems.  
Check that all cables and connectors are securely connected.  
Before fastening FRUs or other parts in place, ensure that no cables are caught on  
screws or the FRU.  
Check that all latches are securely closed.  
Ensure that you have installed all FRUs correctly and do not have any screws left  
over. Using an incorrect screw may damage the thread or screw head and result  
in the FRU not being securely fastened in place.  
After installing FRUs, check that the computer operates correctly.  
Tools and Equipment  
For your safety and the safety of the people around you, it is important that you use  
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) equipment. Correctly utilizing of the equipment increases the  
percentage of successful repairs and saves on the cost of damaged or destroyed parts. The  
following equipment is required for disassembly and assembly.  
One Philips screwdriver with type 0 bit (for THIN HEAD screws)  
One Philips screwdriver with type 1 bit (for screws other than above)  
Tweezers (for lifting screws)  
ESD mats (lay on work table or floor)  
An ESD wrist strap and heel grounder  
Anti-static carpet or flooring  
A pair of needle-nose pliers  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.1 Overview  
Screw Tightening Torque  
Use the following torque when tightening screws.  
CAUTION:  
Overtightening may damage screws or parts. Undertightening may allow  
screws to loosen (and possibly fall out) causing a short circuit or other  
damage.  
NOTE: To tighten screws quickly and accurately, an electric screwdriver is  
recommended.  
M2 (2mm)  
M2.5 (2.5mm) 0.294 N·m(3.0 kgf·cm)  
M3 (3mm) 0.549 N·m(5.6 kgf·cm)  
0.167 N·m (1.7 kgf·cm)  
NOTE: To prevent damage to THIN HEAD screws, press along the axis of the  
screwdriver while turning the screw. This is because the contact area between  
the screw and driver is less than for a pan head screw (standard pan-shaped  
screw head).  
Grip Color  
Some screws have a colored grip area to help you determine the length of the screw.  
“Special length screw” means screws whose length is indicated in an integral number to the  
first decimal places such as 2.5 mm, 2.8 mm and so on.  
4-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.1 Overview  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Screw Notation  
To make maintenance of the computer easier, markings of the kinds of the screws including  
the types and lengths of the screws are indicated on the computer body.  
Format:  
Screw shape + Screw length (mm)  
Screw shape  
B: Bind screw  
F: Thin head screw  
S: Super thin head screw  
T: Tapping screw  
U: Other screws (Unique screws: pan head, stud, etc.)  
Example: B6 ... 6mm bind screw  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.2 Battery Pack/PC Card  
4.2 Battery Pack/PC Card  
4.2.1 Battery Pack  
Removing the battery pack  
The following describes the procedure for removing the battery pack (See Figure 4-1).  
CAUTION: Take care not to short circuit the terminals when removing the battery pack.  
Similarly, do not drop, knock, scratch, disassemble, twist, or bend the battery  
pack.  
1. Turn off the power of the computer.  
2. Disconnect the AC adapter and all other external devices from the computer.  
3. Turn the computer upside down.  
4. Slide the battery lock in the direction indicated by the arrow to unlock.  
5. While sliding the battery latch towards the direction indicated by the arrow, pull out  
the battery pack towards the direction indicated by corresponding arrow.  
Battery Latch  
Battery Lock  
Battery Pack  
Figure 4-1 Removing Battery Pack  
NOTE: For environmental reasons, do not throw away a spent battery pack. Collect the  
spent battery packs.  
4-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.2 Battery Pack/PC Card  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the battery pack  
The following describes the procedure for reinstalling the battery pack (See Figure 4-1).  
CAUTION:  
There is a danger that the lithium ion battery pack may explode if not  
fitted, operated, handled, or disposed correctly. Collect the spent battery  
packs. Use only the batteries approved by Toshiba.  
NOTE: Check visually the battery terminals and clean off any dirt with a dry cloth.  
1. Turn off the power of the computer.  
2. Disconnect the AC adapter and all other external devices from the computer.  
3. Fit the connector of the battery pack to the computer’s connector and push it until  
click sounds.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.2 Battery Pack/PC Card  
4.2.2 PC Card  
Removing the PC card  
The following describes the procedure for removing a PC card (See Figure 4-2).  
CAUTION:  
Insert or remove the PC card in accordance with any instructions in the  
PC card manual or the manuals of the computer system you are using.  
1. Push the eject button. It will pop out when you release it. Then press the eject button  
once more to eject the PC card.  
2. Grasp the PC card and remove it.  
PC Card  
Eject Button  
Figure 4-2 Removing PC Card  
Installing the PC card  
The following describes the procedure for inserting a PC card (See Figure 4-2).  
1. Make sure the eject button does not stick out.  
2. Insert the PC card and press it until it is securely connected.  
4-10  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.3 Memory Module  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.3 Memory Module  
CAUTION:The power of the computer must be turned off when you remove the memory  
module. Removing a memory module with the power on risks damaging the  
module or the computer itself.  
Do not touch the memory module terminals. Any dirt on the terminals may  
cause memory access problems.  
Never press hard or bend the memory module.  
Removing the memory module  
To remove a memory module, confirm that the computer is not in stanby mode or hibernation  
mode. Then perform the following procedure (See Figure 4-3, 4-4).  
1. Turn the computer upside down.  
2. Loosen the screw (with e-ring) securing the memory slot cover.  
3. Remove the memory slot cover from the edge near the screw.  
Memory Slot Cover  
Screw with e-ring  
Figure 4-3 Removing Memory Slot Cover  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.3 Memory Module  
4. Open the left and right latches and remove the memory module.  
SLOT A: Standard Memory  
Memory Module  
Latch  
Latch  
SLOT B: Expansion Memory  
Figure 4-4 Removing Memory Module  
4-12  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.3 Memory Module  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the memory module  
Before installing the memory module, confirm that the computer is not in stanby mode or  
hibernation mode. Then perform the following procedure (See Figure 4-3, 4-4).  
1. Insert the memory module into the connector of the computer slantwise (terminal  
side first) and press it to connect firmly.  
CAUTION:The power must be turned off when you insert a memory module. Inserting a  
memory module with the power on might damage the module or the computer  
itself.  
When installing only one memory module, install it SLOT A. Otherwise, it  
might damage the module or the computer itself  
When installing a memory module, confirm that left anf right latches are  
firmly locked a memor module.  
2. Install the memory slot cover from the front side edge and secure it with the supplied  
screw.  
3. When the power of the computer is turned on, the computer checks automatically the  
memory size. Confirm that the new memory is detected correctly.  
4. If the memory is not detected, make sure it is connected surely.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.4 MDC  
4.4 MDC  
Removing the MDC  
The following describes the procedure for removing an MDC (See Figure 4-5).  
CAUTION:Since the MDC slot cover is easily broken, remove the memory cover first  
before removing the MDC slot cover.  
When replacing the MDC, The power must be turned off when you remove the  
MDC. Removing an MDC with the power on risks damaging the modem or the  
computer itself.  
1. Turn the computer upside down.  
2. Loosen the screw (with e-ring) securing the MDC slot cover and remove the cover.  
3. Remove the following screws fixing the MDC.  
M2x4Z BIND screw  
x2  
4. Lift up the MDC to remove it from the connector on the system board.  
5. Remove the MDC cable from the connector on the MDC.  
Screw with e-ring  
MDC Slot Cover  
M2x4Z BIND  
MDC Cable  
PJ3020  
MDC  
Figure 4-5 Removing MDC  
4-14  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.4 MDC  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the MDC  
The following describes the procedure for installing an MDC(See Figure 4-5).  
1. Connect the MDC cable to the connector JP1 on the MDC.  
2. Set the MDC on the slot and connect the MDC to the connector CN3020 on the  
system board by pressing it from the top.  
3. Fix the MDC using the following screws.  
M2x4Z  
BIND screw  
x2  
4. Install the MDC slot cover and secure it with the supplied screw.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.5 HDD  
4.5 HDD  
Removing the HDD  
The following describes the procedure for removing an HDD (See Figure 4-6 to 4-8).  
CAUTION:  
Take care not to press on the top or bottom of the HDD. Pressure may  
cause data loss or damage to the device.  
1. Turn the computer upside down.  
2. Remove the following screw fixing the HDD slot cover and raise the cover to  
remove.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND screw  
x1  
HDD Slot Cover  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND  
Figure 4-6 Removing HDD Slot Cover  
4-16  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.5 HDD  
4 Replacement Procedures  
3. Holding the tab, pull horizontally the HDD ASSY to disconnect it from the connector  
and remove it.  
HDD ASSY  
Tab  
Figure 4-7 Removing HDD ASSY  
4. Remove the following screws fixing the HDD.  
M3x4S  
THIN BIND screw  
x4  
5. Remove the HDD holder from the HDD.  
M3x4S THIN BIND  
HDD Holder  
M3x4S THIN BIND  
HDD  
Figure 4-8 Removing HDD  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.5 HDD  
Installing the HDD  
The following describes the procedure for installing an HDD (See Figure 4-6 to 4-8).  
1. Install the HDD holder to the HDD with the following screws.  
M3x4S  
THIN BIND screw  
x4  
2. Put the HDD ASSY into the HDD slot and connect it to the connector CN1800 on the  
system board.  
3. Install the HDD slot cover and secure it by using the following screws.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND screw  
x1  
4-18  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.6 Wireless LAN card  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.6 Wireless LAN card  
CAUTION: The power must be turned off when you remove a wireless LAN card.  
Removing a wireless LAN card with the power on risks damaging the card or  
the computer itself.  
Never press hard or bend the wireless LAN card.  
Removing the Wireless LAN card  
The following describes the procedure for removing the wireless LAN card (See Figure 4-9,  
4-10).  
1. Turn the computer upside down.  
2. Remove the following screw fixing the mini PCI slot cover and remove the cover.  
M2x4B  
BIND or LH STICK  
x1  
M2x4B BIND or LH STICK  
Mini PCI Slot Cover  
Figure 4-9 Removing Mini PCI Slot Cover  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.6 Wireless LAN card  
3. Disconnect two wireless LAN cables from connectors on the wireless LAN card.  
4. Peel off one glass tape and two insulators remove the cables from the guide.  
5. Open the left and right latches holding the wireless LAN card and remove the  
wireless LAN card.  
Insulator  
Glass Tape  
Guide  
Wireless LAN Antenna Cable  
Insulator  
Wireless LAN card  
Figure 4-10 Removing Wireless LAN card  
Installing the Wireless LAN card  
The following describes the procedure for installing a wireless LAN card (See Figure 4-9, 4-  
10).  
1. Insert the wireless LAN card terminals at 45-degree slant into the connector on the  
computer and press the wireless LAN card from the top to secure.  
2. Pass the black and white wireless LAN cables along the guide and secure them with  
one glass tape and two insulators.  
3. Connect the wireless LAN cables to the connectors on the wireless LAN card.  
(White cable = MAIN, Black cable = AUX)  
4. Attach the mini PCI slot cover and secure it with the following screw.  
M2x4B BIND or LH STICK  
x1  
4-20  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.7 Cooling Fin/CPU  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.7 Cooling Fin/CPU  
Removing the Cooling fin/CPU  
The following describes the procedure for removing the cooling fin/CPU (See Figure 4-11 to  
4-14).  
1. Remove the following screws fixing the CPU cover and remove the CPU cover.  
M2.5x14B  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
x1  
M2.5x18B  
THIN BIND screw  
M2.5x18B THIN BIND  
M2.5x14B THIN BIND  
CPU Cover  
Figure 4-11 Removing CPU Cover  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.7 Cooling Fin/CPU  
2. Remove the following screws securing the CPU holder on the CPU.  
M2x4B  
BIND screw  
x3  
M2x4B BIND  
CPU Holder  
Figure 4-12 Removing CPU Holder  
4-22  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.7 Cooling Fin/CPU  
4 Replacement Procedures  
3. Lift up the cooling fin and remove it.  
Cooling Fin  
Figure 4-13 Removing Cooling Fin  
4. Unlock the CPU by rotating counterclockwise the cam on the CPU socket by 90  
degrees with a flat-blade screwdriver (in the order shown in the figure below).  
5. Remove the CPU.  
Closed)  
Opened)  
Figure 4-14 Removing CPU  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.7 Cooling Fin/CPU  
Installing the Cooling fin/CPU  
The following describes the procedure for installing the cooling fin/CPU (See Figure 4-11 to  
4-16).  
1. Check that the mark on the cam is in the unlocking position.  
2. Attach the CPU to the correct position in the CPU socket.  
CAUTION: Place the CPU in such direction as shown below. (Pay attention to the  
position of the triangle mark on the CPU.)  
Triangle mark  
Figure 4-15 Installing CPU  
3. Fix the CPU by rotating clockwise the cam by 90 degrees with a flat-blade  
screwdriver.  
4. If there is already silicon grease on the CPU and cooling fin, clean it with a cloth.  
Using a special applicator, apply quarter of scale (0.25ml) of silicon grease evenly on  
the CPU chip.  
NOTE: If silicon grease has already been applied to the CPU or cooling fin, wipe clean  
with a cloth and apply new silicon grease. The computer will not operate correctly if the  
CPU is not firmly in contact with the cooling fin.  
4-24  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.7 Cooling Fin/CPU  
4 Replacement Procedures  
NOTE: Apply the silicon grease enough to cover the chip surface using the special  
applicator. When installing the cooling fin, make sure the bottom of the fin covers the top  
of CPU.  
CPU Chip  
Figure 4-16 Applying Silicon Grease  
5. Install the cooling fin.  
6. Place the CPU holder on the cooling fin with its hole fitted to the boss of the cooling  
fin. Fix the CPU holder with following screws in the order of the marks (1 to 3) on  
the CPU holder.  
M2x4B  
BIND screw  
x3  
7. Install the CPU cover from the front side and secure it with the following screws.  
M2.5x18B  
THIN BIND screw  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
x1  
M2.5x14B  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.8 Keyboard  
4.8 Keyboard  
Removing the Keyboard  
The following describes the procedure for removing the keyboard (See Figure 4-17 to 4-19).  
CAUTION:As the keytop may fall out, when handling the keyboard always hold it by the  
frame and do not touch the keytop.  
1. Open the display.  
2. Hold the both ends of the keyboard holder and lift it up to remove.  
CAUTION:When removing the keyboard holder, be careful not to touch the metal parts of  
the speakers under it.  
Keyboard Holder  
Figure 4-17 Removing Keyboard Holder  
4-26  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.8 Keyboard  
4 Replacement Procedures  
3. Remove the following screws holding the keyboard.  
M2.5×2.8B THIN BIND screw x2  
4. Remove the following screw fixing the keyboard hold plate and remove the  
keyboard hold plate by pulling it to the right side.  
M2.5×2.8B THIN BIND screw x1  
5. Lift the upper side of the keyboard out and bring it a little to the display. Then turn it  
face down on the palm rest.  
M2.5x2.8B THIN BIND  
Keyboard Hold Plate  
Figure 4-18 Removing Keyboard  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.8 Keyboard  
6. Remove the following screw fixing the keyboard support plate underneath the  
keyboard.  
M2.5x8B THIN BIND screw  
7. Remove the keyboard support plate.  
x2  
M2.5x8B THIN BIND  
Keyboard support plate  
Keyboard Flexible Cable  
Glass tape  
CN3200  
Keyboard  
Figure 4-19 Removing Keyboard support plate  
8. Peeling off the glass tape, unlock the connector and remove the keyboard flexible  
cable from the connector CN3200 of the system board.  
4-28  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.8 Keyboard  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the Keyboard  
The following describes the procedure for installing the keyboard (See Figure 4-17 to 4-19).  
1. Place the keyboard on the palm rest as its face is down. Connect the keyboard flexible  
cable to the connector CN3200 on the system board.  
2. Stick the glass tape on the connector CN3200.  
3. Install the keyboard support plate on the keyboard flexible cable from the front side  
part and secure it with the following screws.  
M2.5x8B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
4. Turn the keyboard face up while inserting the bottom edge of the keyboard under the  
chassis. Then put it on the computer. Make sure that there is no gap between the  
keyboard and the computer chassis.  
5. Insert the left side of the keyboard hold plate into the slot of the chassis. Set the plate  
with its hole fitted to the guide pin on the chassis. Secure the keyboard hold plate with  
the following screw. When installing, make sure the keyboard hold plate holds the  
center tab of the keyboard.  
M2.5x2.8B THIN BIND screw x1  
6. Secure the keyboard with the following screws.  
M2.5x2.8B THIN BIND screw x2  
7. Install the keyboard holder by pressing it from the top side.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.9 Switch membrane board  
4.9 Switch membrane board  
Removing the Switch membrane board  
The following describes the procedure for removing the switch membrane board (See Figure  
4-20).  
1. Open the display and unlock the connector. Disconnect the switch membrane board  
cable from the connector CN3280 on the system board.  
2. Remove the following screw securing the switch membrane board.  
M2.5x2.8B  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
3. Slide the switch membrane board to the left and remove it.  
M2.5x2.8B THIN BIND  
Switch membrane board  
Switch membrane  
board Cable  
CN3280  
Figure 4-20 Removing Switch membrane board  
4-30  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.9 Switch membrane board  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the Switch membrane board  
The following describes the procedure for installing the switch membrane board (See Figure  
4-20).  
1. Place the switch membrane board to the left side of the installation position and  
slide it to the right to install. Then fix it with the following screw.  
M2.5x2.8B  
THIN BIND screwx1  
2. Connect the switch membrane board cable to the connector CN3280 on the system  
board.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.10 Optical Drive  
4
4.10 Optical Drive  
NOTE: Do not apply excessive force to the top of an optical drive.  
Removing the Optical drive  
The following describes the procedure for removing the optical drive (See Figure 4-21, 4-22).  
1. Turn the computer face down and remove the following screw securing the optical  
drive assembly.  
M2.5x6B  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
2. Pull out the optical drive assembly in the direction indicated by arrow to remove.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND  
Optical Drive  
Figure 4-21 Removing optical drive  
4-32  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.10 Optical Drive  
4 Replacement Procedures  
3. Remove the following screws fixing the rear bracket from the optical drive assembly.  
M2x2.7 STEP screw  
x2  
4. Remove the following screw fixing the side bracket and remove the side bracket.  
M2x3S  
SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x1  
optical drive assembly  
Side Bracket  
Rear Bracket  
M2x3S SUPER THIN BIND  
M2x2.7 STEP  
Figure 4-22 Removing the bracket  
Installing the Optical drive  
The following describes the procedure for installing the optical drive (See Figure 4-21, 4-22).  
1. Install the side bracket on the optical drive and fix it with the following screw.  
M2x3S  
SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x1  
2. Place the rear bracket on the optical drive and fix it with the following screws.  
M2x2.7 STEP screw  
x2  
3. Insert the optical drive assembly into the slot to connect it to the connector CN1810  
on the system board.  
4. Secure the optical drive assembly with the following screw from the bottom of the  
computer.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND screw  
x1  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.11 Display Assembly  
4.11 Display Assembly  
Removing the Display assembly  
The following describes the procedure for removing the display assembly (See Figure 4-23 to  
4-25).  
1. Close the display and turn the computer face down.  
2. Remove the following screws from the bottom of the computer.  
M2.5x6B  
M2.5x14B  
M2.5x18B  
THIN BIND screw x9 (“6” in the figure)  
THIN BIND screw x5 (“14” in the figure)  
THIN BIND screw x1 (“18” in the figure)  
14  
6
6
14  
6
14  
6
14  
18  
6
6
6
6
14  
6
Figure 4-23 Removing the scerws on the bottom  
4-34  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.11 Display Assembly  
4 Replacement Procedures  
3. Turn the computer face up. Open the display and disconnect the speaker cables  
(Blue, Red) from the connectors on the system board. Unlock the connector and  
disconnect the touch pad cable from the system board.  
4. Remove the following screw securing the LCD harness hold plate and remove the  
LCD harness hold plate. Disconnect the LCD harness from the connector CN5000  
on the system board.  
M2.5x8B  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
5. Remove the following screws securing the display assembly.  
M2x8B  
M2.5x8B  
BIND screw  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
x1  
M2x8B BIND  
M2.5x8B THIN BIND  
M2.5x8B THIN BIND  
Glass tape  
LCD harness  
hold plate  
Right Speaker Cable  
(Connected to CN6002)  
CN3240  
Touch Pad Cable  
Left Speaker Cable  
(Connected to CN6001)  
Figure 4-24 Removing screws and cables (under keyboard)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.11 Display Assembly  
6. Pull out the wireless LAN antenna cables from the slot near the center of the base  
assembly.  
NOTE: When removing the display assembly, be careful not to cut or scratch the wireless  
LAN antenna cables.  
7. Unhook the latches between the display assembly and the base assembly. Lift the  
display assembly up and remove it from the base assembly.  
Display Assembly  
Base Assembly  
Figure 4-25 Removing Display Assembly  
4-36  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.11 Display Assembly  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the Display assembly  
The following describes the procedure for installing the display assembly (See Figure 4-23 to  
4-25).  
1. Pass the wireless LAN antenna cables through the slot near the center of the base  
assembly.  
2. Install the display assembly on the base assembly from the rear of the computer and  
secure them with the following screws.  
M2x8B  
M2.5x8B  
BIND screw  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
x1  
3. Connect the LCD harness to the connector CN5000 on the system board and install  
the LCD harness hold plate with the following screw.  
M2.5x8B  
THIN BIND screw  
x1  
4. Connect the speaker cables (blue, red) to the connectors CN6001, CN6002 on the  
system board.  
5. Connect the touch pad cable to the connector CN3240 on the system board.  
6. Close the display and turn the computer face down. Secure the base assembly with  
the following screws from the bottom.  
M2.5x6B  
M2.5x14B  
M2.5x18B  
THIN BIND screw x9 (“6” in the figure)  
THIN BIND screw x5 (“14” in the figure)  
THIN BIND screw x1 (“18” in the figure)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.12 Sound Board  
4.12 Sound Board  
Removing the Sound Board  
The following describes the procedure for removing the sound board (See Figure 4-26).  
1. Unlock the connector and disconnect the sound board cable from the connector of  
CN9510 on the sound board.  
2. Remove the following screw to remove the sound board.  
3. Unlock the connector and disconnect the sound board cable from the connector  
CN9500 on the system board  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x1  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Sound Board  
Sound Board Cable  
CN9500  
CN9510  
Figure 4-26 Removing Sound Board  
Installing the Sound Board  
The following describes the procedure for installing the sound board (See Figure 4-26).  
1. Connect the sound board cable to the connector CN9510 on the sound board.  
2. Install the sound board on the base assembly and secure it with the following screw.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x1  
3. Connect the sound board cable to the connector CN9500 on the system board.  
4-38  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
Depending on the model, the machine has a different type board (Parallel port board / Serial  
port board / S-Video board). Refer to the proper procedures below.  
4.13.1 Parallel port board  
Removing the Parallel port board  
The following describes the procedure for removing the Parallel port board (See Figure 4-27,  
4-28).  
1. Remove the DC-IN jack and core from the slot of the base assembly.  
2. Remove the following screws to remove the harness holder.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
DC-IN Jack  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Harness Holder  
Figure 4-27 Removing Harness Holder  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
3. Disconnect the USB harness from the connector CN4620 and the parallel port cable  
from the connector CN3503 on the parallel port board.  
4. Remove the parallel port board by lifting it.  
CN4620  
Parallel port board  
CN3503  
DC-IN harness  
Core  
Parallel port cable  
USB harness  
Figure 4-28 Removing parallel port board  
4-40  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the Parallel port board  
The following describes the procedure for installing the Parallel port board (See Figure 4-27,  
4-28).  
1. Install the parallel port board on the base assembly.  
2. Connect the USB harness to the connector CN4620 and the parallel port cable to  
the connector CN3503 on the parallel port board.  
3. Pass the DC-IN harness, USB harness and parallel port cable along the guide of  
base assembly.  
CAUTION:Pass the cables under harness holder as the following figure.  
DC-IN harness  
USB harness  
4. Install the harness holder and secure it with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
5. Set the core of the DC-IN harness on the harness holder and install the DC-IN jack  
in the slot of the base assembly.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
4.13.2 Serial port board  
Removing the serial port board  
The following describes the procedure for removing the serial port board (See Figure 4-27, 4-  
29).  
NOTE: The procedure 1 and 2 are the same items as parallel port board. Refer  
to the figure 4-27 in the parallel port board.  
1. Remove the DC-IN jack and core from the slot of the base assembly.  
2. Remove the following screws to remove the harness holder.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
3. Disconnect the USB harness from the connector CN4630 and the serial port cable  
from the connector CN3504 on the serial port board.  
4. Remove the serial port board by lifting it  
CN4630  
CN3504  
Serial port board  
DC IN harness  
USB harness  
Serial port cable  
Figure 4-29 Removing serial port board  
4-42  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the Serial port board  
The following describes the procedure for installing the Serial port board (See Figure 4-27,  
4-29).  
1. Install the serial port board on the base assembly.  
2. Connect the USB harness to the connector CN4630 and the serial port cable to the  
connector CN3504 on the parallel port board.  
3. Pass the DC-IN harness, USB harness and serial port cable along the guide of base  
assembly.  
CAUTION:Pass the cables under harness holder as the following figure.  
DC-IN harness  
USB harness  
4. Install the harness holder and secure it with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
5. Set the core of the DC-IN harness on the harness holder and install the DC-IN jack  
in the slot of the base assembly.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
4.13.3 S-Video board  
Removing the S-Video board  
The following describes the procedure for removing the S-Video board (See Figure 4-27, 4-  
30).  
NOTE: The procedure 1 and 2 are the same items as parallel port board. Refer  
to the figure 4-27 in the parallel port board.  
1. Remove the DC-IN jack and core from the slot of the base assembly.  
2. Remove the following screws to remove the harness holder.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
3. Disconnect the USB harness from the connector PJ4610 and the S-Video harness  
from the connector PJ5640 on the S-Video board.  
4. Remove the S-Video board by lifting it  
PJ4610  
PJ5640  
S-Video board  
S-Video harness  
USB harness  
Figure 4-30 Removing S-Video board  
4-44  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.13 Parallel port board / Serial port board / S-Video board  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the S-Video board  
The following describes the procedure for installing the S-Video board (See Figure 4-27, 4-  
30).  
1. Install the serial port board on the base assembly.  
2. Connect the USB harness to the connector PJ4610 and the S-Video harness to the  
connector PJ5640 on the S-Video board.  
3. Pass the DC-IN harness, USB harness and S-Video harness along the guide of base  
assembly.  
CAUTION:Pass the cables under harness holder as the following figure.  
DC-IN harness  
USB harness  
S-Video harness  
4. Install the harness holder and secure it with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
5. Set the core of the DC-IN harness on the harness holder and install the DC-IN jack  
in the slot of the base assembly.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.14 Fan  
4.14 Fan  
Removing the Fan  
The following describes the procedure for removing the fan (See Figure 4-31).  
1. Disconnect the fan cable from the connector CN8770 on the system board.  
2. Remove the following screws and remove the fan by raising it up.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
CN8770  
Fan  
Figure 4-31 Removing Fan  
Installing the Fan  
The following describes the procedure for installing the fan (See Figure 4-31).  
1. Connect the fan cable to the connector CN8770 on the system board.  
2. Install the fan on the base assembly and secure it with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
4-46  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.15 System Board/DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.15 System Board/DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery  
CAUTION: When handling the system board, always hold by the edges. Do not touch the  
printed circuit face.  
After replacing the system board with a new one, update the DMI information  
as described Chapter 3. Also update with the latest BIOS as described in  
Appendix G “BIOS/KBC/EC Update”.  
Removing the system board/DC-IN jack/RTC battery  
The following describes the procedure for removing the system board/DC-IN jack/RTC  
battery (See Figure 4-32, 4-33).  
1. Open insulators bundle the LAN harness, Modem harness and RTC battery.  
2. Pull out the RTC battery from the RTC battery case.  
Modem harness  
LAN harness  
RTC Battery Case  
Figure 4-32 Opening the insulators  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.15 System Board/DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery  
3. Remove the LAN harness and Modem harness from the base assembly.  
4. Remove the following screws securing the system board.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
5. [Parallel port board model or Serial port board model] Disconnect the parallel port  
cable or serial port cable from the connector CN3502 on the system board.  
6. [S-VIdeo board model] Disconnect the S-Video harness from the connector CN5340  
on the system board.  
7. Remove the system board from the base assembly.  
8. Turing over the system board, disconnect the DC-IN harness from the connector  
CN8800 and USB harness from the connector PJ4611 on the system board.  
9. Disconnect the RTC battery cable from the connector CN9990 on the system board.  
10. Peel off glass tapes and disconnect the modem harness and LAN harness.  
Glass tape  
CN8800  
DC-IN harness  
Paralle l port cable  
or  
Seria lport cable  
M2.5x4B  
THIN BIND  
Modem harness  
LAN harness  
M2.5x4B  
THIN BIND  
RTC Battery  
PJ4611  
S-Video harness  
CN5340  
USB harness  
CN3502  
Figure 4-33 Removing System board  
4-48  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.15 System Board/DC-IN Jack/RTC Battery  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the System board/DC-IN jack/RTC battery  
The following describes the procedure for installing the system board/DC-IN jack/RTC  
battery (See Figure 4-32, 4-33).  
1. Connect the Modem harness to the connector CN3011 and the LAN harness to  
CN4100 on the back of the system board and secure them with glass tapes.  
2. Connect the RTC battery cable to the connector CN9990 on the system board.  
3. Connect the DC-IN harness to the connector CN8800 and USB harness to the  
connector PJ4611 on the system board.  
4. Secure the system board with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B  
THIN BIND screw x2  
5. [S-VIdeo board model] Connect the S-Video harness to the connector CN5340 on  
the system board.  
6. [Parallel port board model or Serial port board model] Connect the parallel port  
cable or serial port cable to the connector CN3502 on the system board.  
7. Arrange LAN harness, Modem harness and RTC battery cable along the guide.  
CAUTION:Pass the cables around the guide as the following order.  
LAN harness  
RTC battery cable  
Modem harness  
Guide  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.16 PC card cover  
4.16 PC card cover  
Removing the PC card cover  
The following describes the procedure for removing the PC card cover (See Figure 4-34).  
1. Remove the following screws securing the PC card cover.  
M2x4C  
SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x2  
2. Release the hooks securing the PC card cover and remove the PC card cover.  
PC card cover  
hook  
M2x4C SUPER THIN BIND  
Figure 4-34 Removing the PC card cover  
Installing the PC card cover  
The following describes the procedure for installing the PC card cover (See Figure 4-34).  
1. Secure the hooks and install the PC card cover.  
2. Secure the PC card cover with the following screws.  
M2x4C  
SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x2  
4-50  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.17 Battery Latch  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.17 Battery Latch  
Removing the Battery latch  
The following describes the procedure for removing the battery latch (See Figure 4-35, 4-36).  
1. While pressing projections of the SB latch button inside each other, push the SB  
latch button to the bottom of the base assembly to remove.  
Base Assembly  
Projection of the SB latch button  
Figure 4-35 Removing SB Latch Button  
2. Remove the battery lock L from the base assembly and remove the spring from the  
battery lock L.  
Battery Lock L  
SB Latch Button  
Spring  
(Back view)  
Projection  
Base Assembly  
Figure 4-36 Removing Battery Lock L  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.17 Battery Latch  
Installing the Battery latch  
The following describes the procedure for installing the battery latch (See Figure 4-35, 4-36).  
1. Set the spring to the battery lock L and install it on the base assembly.  
2. Install the SB latch button from the bottom of the base assembly and snap their  
projections to the battery lock L. When installing the button, make sure the triangle  
mark on the back side is located in the indicated position. After installation, slide the  
latch on the bottom of the base assembly to make sure it works properly.  
4-52  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.18 Battery Lock  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.18 Battery Lock  
Removing the Battery lock  
The following describes the procedure for removing the battery lock (See Figure 4-34, 4-35).  
1. While pressing projections of the battery lock button inside each other, push the  
button to the bottom of the base assembly to remove.  
Base Assembly  
Projection of the battery lock button  
Figure 4-37 Removing Battery Lock Button  
2. Remove the battery lock R from the base assembly and remove the spring from the  
battery lock R.  
Battery Lock Button  
Mark  
(Back view)  
Spring  
Projection  
Battery Lock R  
Base Assembly  
Figure 4-38 Removing Battery Lock R  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.18 Battery Lock  
Installing the Battery lock  
The following describes the procedure for installing the battery latch (See Figure 4-37, 4-38).  
1. Set the spring to the battery lock R and install it on the base assembly.  
2. Install the battery lock button from the bottom of the base assembly and snap their  
projections to the battery lock R. When installing the button, make sure the mark  
on the back side is located in the indicated position. After installation, slide the latch  
on the bottom of the base assembly to make sure it works properly.  
4-54  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.19 Touch Pad  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.19 Touch Pad  
Removing the Touch pad  
The following describes the procedure for removing the touch pad (See Figure 4-36).  
1. Remove the following screws securing the touch pad.  
M2.5x4B  
THIN BIND screw x6  
2. Remove the touch pad and touch pad switch by raising.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Touch Pad Cable  
Touch Pad  
Touch Pad Switch  
Figure 4-39 Removing Touch Pad  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.19 Touch Pad  
Installing the Touch pad  
The following describes the procedure for installing the touch pad (See Figure 4-39).  
1. Place the touch pad switch fitting to bosses.  
2. Place the touch pad according to the guide pins.  
3. Secure the touch pad with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x6  
4-56  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter  
Removing the LCD unit/FL inverter  
The following describes the procedure for removing the LCD unit and FL inverter (See  
Figure 4-40 to 4-42).  
1. Peel off two mask seals from the front of the display mask and remove the following  
screws.  
M2.5x6B  
THIN BIND screw  
x2  
2. Insert your fingers between the display mask and the LCD and remove the display  
mask after unlatching the display mask.  
Mask Seal  
Display Mask  
M2.5×6B THIN BIND  
Figure 4-40 Removing Display Mask  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter  
3. Remove the following screw fixing the FL inverter.  
M2x4Z  
SUPER THIN BIND screw x1  
4. Peel off the insulators in the HV cable side and disconnect two cables from the FL  
inverter. Remove the FL inverter.  
5. Remove the following screws fixing the LCD unit.  
M2x4Z  
SUPER THIN BIND screw x4  
6. With the bottom edge of the LCD unit resting on the display cover, raise the top edge  
of the LCD unit. Peel off the cupper tape and disconnect the LCD harness from the  
connector on the back of the LCD.  
7. Remove the LCD unit from the display cover.  
Cupper Tape  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN BIND  
Insulator1  
FL Inverter  
LCD harness  
Insulator2  
HV cable  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN BIND  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN BIND  
Figure 4-41 Removing FL Inverter and LCD Unit  
4-58  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter  
4 Replacement Procedures  
8. Remove the following screws securing the LCD brackets. Remove the LCD  
brackets from the LCD module.  
M2x3 SUPER THIN BIND screw x4  
M2x3C SUPER THIN BIND  
LCD Bracket  
M2x3C SUPER THIN BIND  
Figure 4-42 Removing LCD Bracket  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.20 LCD Unit/FL Inverter  
Installing the FL inverter/LCD unit  
The following describes the procedure for installing the LCD unit/FL inverter (See Figure 4-  
40 to 4-42).  
1. Secure the LCD brackets to the LCD module with the following screws.  
M2x3C SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x4  
2. Stand the LCD unit on the display cover and connect the LCD harness to the back of  
the LCD. Fix it with the cupper tape.  
3. Put the LCD unit on the display cover and secure the LCD with the following screws.  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x4  
4. Connect LCD harness and HV cable to the connectors on the FL inverter.  
5. Secure the FL inverter with the following screw.  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN BIND screw  
x1  
6. Stick the insulators on the HV cable side and tuck the insulator1 under LCD unit.  
7. Install the display mask and engage the latches.  
NOTE: When installing the display mask, make sure there is no gap between the display  
mask and the display cover.  
8. Secure the display mask with the following screws and stick two mask seals on the  
front of the display mask.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
4-60  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.21 Latch Assembly  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.21 Latch Assembly  
Removing the Latch assembly  
The following describes the procedure for removing latch assembly (See Figure 4-43).  
1. Press the latch assembly in the direction indicated by arrow to remove it from the  
display cover.  
Latch  
Display Cover  
Hook  
Spring  
Figure 4-43 Removing Latch Assembly  
Installing the Latch Assembly  
The following describes the procedure for installing the Latch Assembly (See Figure 4-43).  
1. Set the spring on the hook and fit the hook on the slot of display cover.  
2. Install the hook and latch by fitting projections on the latch to the holes of the hook.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
Removing the Wireless LAN antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
The following describes the procedure for removing the wireless LAN antenna, speaker and  
hinge (See Figure 4-44 to 4-52).  
1. Peel off eight glass tapes securing the wireless LAN antenna cables (white and  
black). Remove the wireless LAN antennas. Turn the display assembly face down  
and unhook the wireless LAN antenna cable from the guides.  
[If Sharp–made LCD is installed] Remove two sponges from the display assembly.  
[If LG Philips–made LCD is installed] Remove one gasket and two aluminum tapes  
from the display assembly.  
[Samsung-made LCD]  
Glass Tape  
Wireless LAN  
antenna cable  
Glass Tape  
Glass Tape  
Wireless LAN antenna  
4-62  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
4 Replacement Procedures  
[Sharp-made LCD]  
Glass Tape  
Wireless LAN  
antenna cable  
Glass Tape  
Sponge  
Glass Tape  
Wireless LAN antenna  
Sponge  
[LG Philips-made LCD]  
Glass Tape  
Wireless LAN  
antenna cable  
Glass Tape  
Aluminum Tape  
Gasket  
Glass Tape  
Aluminum Tape  
Wireless LAN antenna  
Figure 4-44 Removing wireless LAN antennas  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
2. Remove the following screw securing the LCD harness holder to remove it.  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN screw x1  
M2x4Z SUPER THIN  
LCD harness Holder  
Insulator  
slot  
Figure 4-45 Removing LCD harness Holder  
3. Remove the following screws securing the display cover to the hinges.  
M2.5x6C PSP TIGHT screw  
M2x5C SUPER THIN screw  
x4  
x2  
4. Remove the display cover from the hinges.  
M2.5x6C PSP TIGHT  
Display cover  
M2.5x6C PSP TIGHT  
M2x5C SUPER THIN  
Figure 4-46 Removing display cover  
4-64  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
4 Replacement Procedures  
5. Remove the following screws securing the hinge caps and remove the hinge caps.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND screw  
6. Remove the LCD harness.  
x2  
7. Remove the wireless LAN antenna cables.  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND  
Hinge Cap  
Insulator  
M2.5x6B THIN BIND  
LCD harness  
Wireless LAN Antenna Cable  
Figure 4-47 Removing Hinge Cap  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
8. Remove the following screws securing the optical drive cover from the back of the  
display assembly. To remove the optical drive cover, pull it out to the right hinge first.  
M2.5x2.8B U-THIN BIND screw x3  
M2.5x4B  
THIN BIND screw  
x2  
M2.5x2.8B U-THIN BIND  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Optical Drive Cover  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
“A”  
Figure 4-48 Removing Optical drive cover  
4-66  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
4 Replacement Procedures  
9. Remove the following screws securing the hinges to the display assembly.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw x3 (Right:1, Left: 2)  
10. Peel off the accetate tapes securing the speaker cables and take out the cable under  
the insulator.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Hinge  
Insulator  
Hinge  
Accetate Tape  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Speaker cable  
Figure 4-49 Removing speaker cables  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
11. Remove the following screws securing the speakers.  
M2. 5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x2  
CAUTION: When removing the speakers, be careful not to touch the metal part of the  
speakers. It might damage the speakers.  
12. Peel off insulators and pull out the speaker cable (blue) to the front. Pull out the  
cable from the guide and remove the left speaker. Pull out right speaker to remove.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Left speaker  
Insulator  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND  
Right speaker  
Speaker Cable (blue)  
Figure 4-50 Removing Speakers  
13. Shift the hinges inside and pull out them to remove.  
Hinge  
Figure 4-51 Removing Hinges  
4-68  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Installing the Wireless LAN antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
The following describes the procedure for installing the wireless LAN antenna, speaker and  
hinge (See Figure 4-44 to 4-52).  
CAUTION: When installing the speakers, be careful not to touch the metal part of the  
speakers. It might damage the speakers.  
1. Install the hinges to the display assembly and secure them with the following screws.  
M2.5x4B THIN BIND screw  
x3 (Right:1, Left: 2)  
2. Attach sponges on both the side of each speaker.  
Left Speaker  
Right Speaker  
Sponge  
Sponge  
Figure 4-52 Attaching sponges  
3. Set the left speaker on the base assembly. Pass the left speaker cable (blue) along  
the guide on the front of the display assembly and run toward the back side. Secure  
the cable with four insulators.  
4. Set the right speaker on the base assembly and pass the right speaker cable (red)  
toward the back side of the base assembly.  
5. Arrange the speaker cables (blue and red) along the guides. Pass the cables under the  
insulator and secure them with accetate tapes. Insert the insulator end under the  
hinge.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.22 Wireless LAN Antenna/Speaker/Hinge  
6. Install the optical drive cover and secure it with the following screws. When  
installing, insert the “A” portion (in the figure) first.  
M2.5x2.8B  
M2.5x4B  
U-THIN BIND screw x3  
THIN BIND screw x2  
7. Install the display cover on the display assembly. Secure the hinges and the display  
cover with the following screws.  
M2.5x6C  
M2x5C  
PSP TIGHT screw x4  
SUPER THIN screw x2  
8. Fit the wireless LAN antennas to the lines on the back side of the display cover. Pass  
the wireless LAN antenna cables and secure them with eight glass tapes.  
[If Sharp–made LCD is installed] Stick two sponges along the guide of the display  
assembly.  
[If LG Philips–made LCD is installed] Stick one gasket and two aluminum tapes  
along the guide of the display assembly.  
9. Pass the wireless LAN antenna cables to the back side of the display assembly.  
10. Install the LCD harness and LCD harness holder on it. Secure the plate with the  
following screw. When installing the LCD harness holder, hook the right projection  
to the edge of the chassis and secure the cable with the insulator.  
M2x4Z  
SUPER THIN screw  
x1  
11. Install the right and left hinge caps and secure them with the following screws.  
M2.5x6B  
THIN BIND screw  
x2  
12. Pass the wireless LAN antenna cable to the back side of the base assembly and  
arrange them along the guides. Pass the cables to the center of the base assembly.  
4-70  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
This system uses LCD modules from the following suppliers. The procedure for replacing the  
fluorescent lamp is different for each LCD module. Refer to the appropriate procedure.  
Type  
15.0 inch  
(XGA)  
Part No.  
Supplier  
Samsung  
Section  
4.23.1  
4.23.2  
4.23.3  
G33C0002W110  
G33C0002Y110  
G33C00030110  
Sharp  
LG.Philips  
15.0 inch  
(SXGA+)  
G33C0001X210  
LG.Philips  
4.23.4  
NOTE: - When working with a LCD module, always use a flat, grounded table.  
(1) Handle the backlight unit in the environment without dust, such as on the clean  
bench. Keep the worktable free from any screws or other material that may scratch  
the LCD surface.  
(2) Use an anti-static or protective sheet.  
(3) When replacing the FL unit, cover with a finger protector or similar to prevent  
dirtying or scratching the LCD panel.  
(4) Take care when handling the lamp. Excessive force may break the lamp.  
(5) Take care not to dirty or deform the lamp reflector.  
(6) Ensure always that the power of the LCD module is turned off before connecting or  
disconnecting cables and connectors.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4.23.1 Replacing the 15.0 Inch XGA Samsung Fluorescent Lamp  
Disassembling the 15.0 Inch XGA Samsung Fluorescent Lamp  
To disassemble the 15.0 inch XGA Samsung fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below and  
refer to figures4-53 to 4-61.  
1. Remove the PCB cover.  
NOTE: When removing the PCB cover, be careful not to damage the COF.  
PCB cover  
Figure 4-53 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (1)  
4-72  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
2. Remove the two screws.  
Screw  
Screw  
Figure 4-54 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (2)  
3. Remove the four screws from the top chassis.  
Screw  
Screw  
Screw  
Screw  
Figure 4-55 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (3)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4. Remove the four bottom hooks and four side hooks (left and right). Then remove the  
top chassis from the mold frame.  
Side hook  
Side hook  
Bottom hook  
Figure 4-56 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (4)  
4-74  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
5. Remove the panel assembly from the mold frame.  
NOTE: When removing the panel assembly, be careful not to damage the COF.  
Panel assembly  
Mold frame  
Figure 4-57 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (5)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
6. Remove the sheets and clips.  
1) Remove the two clips fixing the sheets.  
2) Remove the sheets (protection sheet, prism sheet (L, U), diffusion sheet, LGP  
and reflection sheet).  
Clip  
Clip  
Sheets  
Figure 4-58 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (6)  
4-76  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
7. Remove the lamp back cover.  
1) Remove the two screws from the lamp back cover.  
2) Remove the lamp back cover.  
Screw  
Screw  
Lamp back cover  
Figure 4-59 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (7)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
8. Remove the lamp wire from the wire guide of the mold frame.  
Lamp wire  
Figure 4-60 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (8)  
4-78  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
9. Remove the lamp assembly from the mold frame.  
Lamp assembly  
Mold frame  
Figure 4-61 Replacing 15.0 Inch Samsung fluorescent lamp (XGA) (9)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Assembling the 15.0-inch XGA Samsumg Fluorescent Lamp  
The assembly procedure of the 15.0-inch XGA Samsung fluorescent lamp is the reverse of the  
above disassembly procedure.  
4-80  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23.2 Replacing the 15.0 Inch XGA Sharp Fluorescent lamp  
Disassembling the 15.0 Inch XGA Sharp Fluorescent lamp  
To disassemble the 15.0-inch XGA Sharp fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below and refer  
to Figures 4-62 to 4-71.  
1. Turn the LCD module face down, and remove the protection cover S (A), protection  
cover G (B), fixing tape (C) and fixing tape for lead wire (D).  
NOTE: 1) Be careful not to damage the TCP or chips.  
2) The protection cover G is reused. Discard the other tapes removed.  
(A) Protection cover S  
(C) Fixing tape  
(B) Protection cover G  
(D) Fixing tape for lead wire  
Figure 4-62 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (1)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
2. Remove the four screws on the sides.  
Screw loosening torque: 1.2kgcm  
Screw  
Screw  
Screw  
Screw  
Figure 4-63 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (2)  
3. Turn the LCD module face up and remove the bezel (E).  
(3) Release the hook of the  
bezel from the lamp cover.  
(E) Bezel  
< Side view >  
Hook  
(1) Release the bezel from the  
four latches of the lamp cover.  
(2) Release the two latches (left and right)  
on the P-chassis.  
Figure 4-64 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (3)  
4-82  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4. Turn the LCD module face down and remove the two screws fixing the board. Then  
open the bent portion of the TCP of the board and remove the backlight.  
Screw loosening torque: 1.2kgcm  
Screw  
Screw  
Figure 4-65 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (4)  
Do not hold the  
Do not hold the  
Raise the board and make this condition.  
Figure 4-66 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (5)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
5. Turn the LCD module face up and remove the LCD panel (I) from the backlight unit  
(H).  
CAUTION: Wear finger sacks or gloves during the work not to soil or scratch the LCD  
panel or backlight unit.  
(I) LCD panel  
(H) Backlight unit  
Figure 4-67 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (6)  
4-84  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
6. Turn the backlight unit (H) removed face down and remove the two screws (D) and  
lamp cover (J).  
NOTE: Be careful not to scratch or soil the sheets.  
(H) Backlight unit  
Screw loosening torque: 1.2kgcm  
(D) Screw  
(D) Screw  
(J) Lamp cover  
Figure 4-68 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (7)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
7. Turn the backlight unit face up and remove the upper diffusion sheet (K), lens sheet  
(L) and light guide (M).  
NOTE: Be careful not to scratch or soil the removed sheets or light guide to reuse them.  
Do not remove the reflection sheet  
under the light guide.  
(K) Upper diffusion sheet  
(L) Lens sheet  
(M) Light guide  
Figure 4-69 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (8)  
8. Remove the four double-sided tapes (N, O, P, Q).  
4-86  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
NOTE: Discard the removed tapes. Do not reuse them.  
(N) Double-sided tape 1  
(P) Double-sided tape 3  
(O) Double-sided tape 2  
(Q) Double-sided tape 4  
Figure 4-70 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (9)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
9. Turn the backlight unit face down and remove the lamp unit (R) from the P-chassis.  
CAUTION: When removing the lamp unit, be careful not to break the lamp, or bend the  
reflection sheet.  
P-chassis  
Lamp unit (R)  
Figure 4-71 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (10)  
4-88  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
Assembling the 15.0 Inch XGA Sharp Fluorescent Lamp  
To assemble the 15.0-inch Sharp XGA fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below and refer to  
Figures 4-72 to 4-84.  
1. Stick the four double-sided tapes (N, O, P, Q) on the P-chassis.  
Standard for edge of P-chassis  
(P)  
Do not make the P-chassis over this line.  
(N)  
0 to 1 mm  
(O)  
(Q)  
Figure 4-72 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (11)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
2. Turn the backlight unit face down and install a new lamp unit (R) on the P-chassis.  
NOTE: When install the lamp unit (R), be careful not to bend or damage the reflection  
sheet.  
P-chassis  
(R) Lamp unit  
Figure 4-73 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (12)  
Z
Z
Install the lamp unit without floating.  
Install the reflection sheet as it is  
placed inside the reflector.  
Install the lead wire into this groove.  
Cross-section drawing of Z-Z  
Figure 4-74 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (13)  
4-90  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
3. Install the lamp cover (J) on the backlight unit and secure it with the two screws (D).  
(J) Lamp cover  
Screw tightening torque: 1.0kgcm  
(D) Screw  
(D) Screw  
Figure 4-75 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (14)  
4. Install the light guide (M) on the backlight unit.  
Insert the light guide straight not  
to deform the reflector.  
Backlight unit  
(M) Light guide  
Figure 4-76 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (15)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
5. Place the lens sheet (L) and upper diffusion sheet (K) on the backlight unit with light  
guide(M).  
(K) Upper diffusion sheet  
(L) Lens sheet  
(M) Light guide  
Do not make any sheet over  
the edge of P-chassis.  
Figure 4-77 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (16)  
6. Place the LCD panel (I) on the backlight unit (H).  
4-92  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
NOTE: Make sure there is no dust between the LCD panel and backlight unit. If any dust  
is found, remove it with crepe tape or others which has no remaining of paste.  
(I) LCD panel  
Guide rib  
Guide rib  
Guide rib  
(H) Backlight unit  
Guide rib  
Make sure the LCD panel is  
installed in the guide rib  
Figure 4-78 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (17)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
7. Bend the TCP attaching to the source board and secure it with the two screws.  
Do not hold the edge.  
Do not hold the edge.  
Figure 4-79 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (18)  
Screw  
Screw  
Figure 4-80 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (19)  
4-94  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
8. Install the bezel (E) on the lamp cover and hook the four latches on the lamp cover and  
two latches on the P-chassis.  
(E) Bezel  
(1) Hitch the hook of the bezel  
on the rib of the P-chassis.  
<Side view>  
Hook  
(2) Lean the bezel on the lamp cover without  
interference with the TCP.  
Figure 4-81 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (20)  
Make sure of mating of the bezel and the rib of the P-chassis.  
Make sure of mating the bezel and  
the latch of the P-chassis.  
Make sure of mating of the bezel  
and the latch of the P-chassis.  
Figure 4-82 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (21)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
9. Secure the sides of the unit with the four screws.  
Screw  
Screw  
Screw  
Screw  
Figure 4-83 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (22)  
4-96  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4 Replacement Procedures  
10. Stick the protection cover G (B), protection cover S (A), fixing tape (C) and fixing tape  
for lead wire (D).  
(A)  
(C)  
(B)  
0 to 1 mm  
(D)  
Do not make the tape over the top of the module.  
The tape MUST NOT appear on the display.  
Stick the tape according to the outline of  
the LCD module. Make sure the tape does  
not appear on the side of the module.  
Figure 4-84 Replacing 15.0 Inch Sharp fluorescent lamp (XGA) (23)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4
4.23.3 Replacing the 15.0 Inch XGA LG.Philips Fluorescent lamp  
CAUTION: When replacing the fluorescent lamp, wear finger covers or gloves to avoid  
contaminating or damaging the LCD panel. Be careful not to let dust or  
other foreign substance into the module.  
Disassembling the 15.0 Inch XGA LG.Philips Fluorescent lamp  
To disassemble the 15.0-inch XGA LG.Philips fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below and  
refer to Figures 4-85 to 4-88.  
1. Remove the outside tape and cover shield.  
1) Remove the adhesive tape fixing the B/L wire and Top case. Be careful not to  
apply to the B/L wire.  
2) Remove the cover shield (G). Be careful not to apply excessive force to the  
gate COF and source PCB.  
CUATION: Wear anti-static gloves to prevent circuit damage caused by ESC.  
Cover shield  
Cover shield  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Figure 4-85 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (1)  
4-98  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
2. Remove the top case. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the source TCP and  
gate COF.  
Top case  
Figure 4-86 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (2)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
3. Remove the source PCB.  
1) Remove the source PCB. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the PCB  
and TCP.  
Figure 4-87 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (3)  
4-100  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
4. Remove the board assembly, adhesive tape, light guide and cover assembly bottom.  
1) Remove the board assembly.  
2) Remove the adhesive tape securing the sheets (four points).  
3) Remove the sheets and light guide.  
NOTE: No penetration of foreign object is indispensable not to scratch the sheets.  
4) Remove the screw and cover assembly bottom.  
NOTE: Maximum value of torque is 1.5kgcm.  
Board assembly  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Sheets  
&
Light guide  
Screw  
Screw  
Cover assembly bottom  
Figure 4-88 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (4)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Assembling the 15.0-inch XGA LG.Philips Fluorescent lamp  
To assemble the 15.0-inch XGA LG.Philips fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below and  
refer to Figures 4-89 to 4-92.  
1. Install the cover assembly bottom, sheets, light guide, adhesive tape and board  
assembly.  
1) Secure the cover assembly bottom with the two screws.  
2) Install the light guide and sheets. (Secure the reflection sheets with double-  
sided tape.)  
NOTE: No penetration of foreign object is indispensable not to scratch the surface of the  
sheets.  
3) Stick the adhesive tape to fix the sheets.  
4) Install the board assembly.  
NOTE: Do not apply excessive force to the PCB and TCP.  
Board assembly  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Sheets  
&
Light guide plate  
Screw  
Screw  
Cover assembly bottom  
Figure 4-89 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (5)  
4-102  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
2. Install the source PCB.  
1) Install the source PCB. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the TCP.  
Figure 4-90 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (6)  
3. Install the top case.  
Figure 4-91 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (7)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4. Stick the outside tape and install the cover shield.  
1) Install the cover shield.  
CAUTION: Wear anti-static gloves to prevent circuit damage to the source PCB.  
2) Stick the adhesive tape to fix the top case and B/L wire.  
Cover shield  
Cover shield  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Figure 4-92 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (XGA) (8)  
4-104  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23.4 Replacing the 15.0 Inch SXGA+ LG.Philips Fluorescent lamp  
CAUTION: When you replace the fluorescent lamp, wear finger covers or gloves to  
avoid contaminating or damaging the LCD module. Be careful not to let  
dust or other foreign substances into the LCD module.  
Disassembling the 15.0 Inch SXGA+ LG.Philips Fluorescent lamp  
To disassemble the 15.0-inch SXGA+ LG.Philips fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below  
and refer to Figures 4-93 to 4-96.  
5. Remove the outside tape and cover shield.  
1) Remove the adhesive tape fixing the B/L wire. Be careful not to apply  
excessive force to the B/L wire.  
2) Remove the cover shield (G). Be careful not to apply excessive force to the  
gate TCP.  
3) Remove the cover shield (C). Be careful not to apply excessive force to the  
source PCB.  
CAUTION: Wear anti-static gloves to prevent circuit damage caused by ESC.  
4) Remove the tape shield and adhesive tape fixing the top case. Be careful not to  
apply excessive force to the top case.  
Cover shield (C)  
Cover shield (G)  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Tape shield  
Figure 4-93 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (1)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
6. Remove the top case. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the top case or gate  
TCP.  
Top case  
Figure 4-94 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (2)  
7. Remove the source PCB and gate PCB.  
1) Remove the source PCB. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the PCB or  
TCP when removing double-sided tape.  
2) Remove the gate PCB. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the PCB or  
TCP when removing double-sided tape.  
4-106  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
Source PCB  
Gate PCB  
Figure 4-95 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (3)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
8. Remove the board assembly, adhesive tape, light guide and cover assembly bottom  
(L).  
1) Remove the board assembly.  
NOTE: This process should be made in a clean room to prevent scratch or particle on  
polarizer or B/L assembly.  
2) Remove the adhesive tape fixing the sheets (four points).  
3) Remove the sheets and light guide.  
NOTE: No penetration of foreign object is indispensable not to scratch on the surface of  
each sheet.  
4) Remove the two screws fixing the cover assembly bottom (L).  
NOTE: Maximum value of torque is 1.5kgcm.  
Board assembly  
Adhesive tape  
Double-sided tape  
Adhesive tape  
Double-sided tape  
Adhesive tape  
Sheets and light guide  
Adhesive tape  
Screw  
Screw  
Cover assembly bottom (L)  
Figure 4-96 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (4)  
4-108  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
Assembling the 15.0 Inch SXGA+ LG.Philips Fluorescent lamp  
To assembling the 15.0-inch SXGA+ LG.Philips fluorescent lamp, follow the steps below  
and refer to figures 4-97 to 4-100.  
1. Install the cover assembly bottom (L), sheets, light guide, adhesive tape and board  
assembly.  
1) Remove the protect sheet from the cover assembly bottom (L).  
2) Secure the cover assembly bottom (L) with the two screws.  
NOTE: Maximum value of torque is 2.0kgcm.  
3) Install the light guide and sheets. (Secure the reflection sheet with double-  
sided tape.)  
NOTE: No penetration of foreign object is indispensable not to scratch on the surface of  
the sheets and light guide.  
4) Stick the adhesive tape to fix the sheets.  
5) Install the board assembly. (Secure the gate PCB with double-sided tape.)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
NOTE: Be careful not to apply excessive force to the PCB and TCP.  
Board assembly  
Adhesive tape  
Double-sided tape  
Double-sided tape  
Adhesive  
Double-sided tape  
Double-sided tape  
Adhesive tape  
Sheets and light  
Adhesive tape  
Screw  
Screw  
Cover assembly bottom (L)  
Figure 4-97 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (5)  
4-110  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
2. Install the source PCB and gate PCB.  
1) Install the source PCB. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the TCP.  
2) Install the gate PCB. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the TCP.  
Source PCB  
Gate PCB  
Figure 4-98 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (6)  
3. Install the top case. Be careful not to apply excessive force to the gate TCP.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Top case  
Figure 4-99 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (7)  
4-112  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
Replacement Procedures  
4. Stick the out side tape and cover shield.  
1) Install the tape shield and adhesive tape to fix the top case. Be careful not to  
apply excessive force to the top case.  
2) Install the cover shield (C). Be careful not to apply excessive force to the  
control PCB.  
CAUTION: Wear anti-static gloves to prevent circuit damage caused by ESC.  
3) Install the cover shield (G). Be careful not to apply excessive force to the gate  
TCP.  
4) Stick the adhesive tape to fix the B/L wire. Be careful not to apply excessive  
force to the B/L wire.  
Cover shield (C)  
Cover shield (G)  
Adhesive tape  
Adhesive tape  
Tape shield  
Figure 4-100 Replacing 15.0 Inch LG.Philips fluorescent lamp (SXGA+) (8)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
4-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacement Procedures  
4.23 Fluorescent Lamp  
4-114  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
App-ii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix  
Contents  
Appendix A Handling the LCD Module......................................................................... A-1  
Appendix B Board Layout................................................................................................B-1  
B.1  
B.2  
B.3  
B.4  
B.5  
B.6  
System Board Front View..............................................................................B-1  
System Board Back View..............................................................................B-3  
Sound Board (FLGSN*) ................................................................................B-5  
Parallel port Board (FLGCP*).......................................................................B-6  
Serial port Board (FLGSR*)..........................................................................B-7  
S-Video Board (FLKCS*) .............................................................................B-8  
Appendix C Pin Assignment............................................................................................ C-1  
System Board  
C.1  
C.2  
C.3  
C.4  
C.5  
C.6  
C.7  
C.8  
C.9  
CN1400 Memory 0 Connector (200-pin) ..................................................... C-1  
CN1410 Memory 1 Connector (200-pin) .................................................... C-5  
CN1800 HDD I/F Connector (44-pin)......................................................... C-8  
CN1810 Optical Drive I/F Connector (50-pin)............................................ C-9  
IS2110 PC Card I/F Connector (70-pin).................................................... C-10  
CN2300 Docking I/F connector (240-pin)................................................. C-12  
CN2200 Mini PCI I/F Connector (124-pin)............................................... C-16  
CN3010 MDC I/F Connector (12-pin) ...................................................... C-18  
CN3490 Debug Port Connector (12-pin).................................................... C-18  
C.10 CN3200 Keyboard I/F Connector (34-pin)................................................ C-19  
C.11 CN3240 Touch Pad I/F Connector (4-pin) ................................................. C-19  
C.12 CN3280 Switch Board I/F Connector (10-pin).......................................... C-20  
C.13 CN3502 FLGCP/FLGSR Board I/F Connector (30-pin)............................ C-20  
C.14 CN4100 Network I/F Connector (14-pin).................................................. C-21  
C.15 CN4611 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)............................................. C-21  
C.16 CN4610 USB I/F Connector 0 (4-pin)....................................................... C-21  
C.17 CN5000 LCD I/F Connector (41-pin)........................................................ C-21  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
App-iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
C.18 CN5620 RGB I/F Connector (15-pin) ........................................................ C-23  
C.19 CN5340 S-Video I/F Connector (5-pin) .................................................... C-23  
C.20 CN6001 Speaker Connector (Left) (3-pin)................................................ C-23  
C.21 CN6002 Speaker Connector (Right) (2-pin).............................................. C-24  
C.22 CN9500 Sound Board I/F Connector (18-pin)........................................... C-24  
C.23 CN8800 DC-IN Connector (4-pin)............................................................. C-24  
C.24 CN8020 1st Battery Connector (10-pin)..................................................... C-25  
C.25 CN9990 RTC Battery Connector (3-pin).................................................... C-25  
C.26 CN8770 FAN I/F Connector (4-pin)........................................................... C-25  
Sound Board (FLGSN*)  
C.27 J6070 External Microphone Connector (6-pin).......................................... C-26  
C.28 J6310 Headphone Connector (6-pin).......................................................... C-26  
C.29 CN9510 System Board I/F Connector (18-pin).......................................... C-26  
Switch Board (FLKSW*)  
C.30 PJ3280 System Board I/F Connector (10-pin)............................................ C-27  
Parallel Board (FLGCP*)  
C.31 CN3503 System Board I/F Connector (30-pin).......................................... C-28  
C.32 CN4613 Parallel I/F Connector (25-pin) ................................................... C-29  
C.33 CN4620 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)............................................. C-29  
C.34 CN4622 USB I/F Connector 1 (4-pin)....................................................... C-29  
S-Video Board (FLGCS*)  
C.35 PJ4610 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)................................................ C-30  
C.36 PJ4612 USB I/F Connector 1 (4-pin) ......................................................... C-30  
C.37 PJ4611 USB I/F Connector 2 (4-pin) ......................................................... C-30  
C.38 PJ5640 System Board I/F Connector (5-pin).............................................. C-31  
C.39 PJ5641 Sss-Video Connector (4-pin).......................................................... C-31  
Serial Board (FLGSR*)  
C.40 CN3504 System Board I/F Connector (30-pin).......................................... C-32  
C.41 CN3440 Serial I/F Connector (9-pin) ......................................................... C-33  
C.42 CN4630 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin).............................................. C-33  
C.43 CN4632 USB I/F Connector 1 (4-pin)........................................................ C-33  
App-iv  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes.............................................................. D-1  
D.1  
Appendix E Key Layout ...................................................................................................E-1  
E.1 Keyboard Layout ...........................................................................................E-1  
Appendix F Wiring Diagrams..........................................................................................F-1  
Keyboard Scan/Character Codes .................................................................. D-1  
F.1  
F.2  
RGB monitor ID Wraparound Connector (15-Pin to 15-Pin)........................F-1  
Parallel Port Wraparound Connector.............................................................F-1  
Appendix G BIOS/KBC/EC Update...............................................................................G-1  
Appendix H Reliability.....................................................................................................H-1  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
App-v  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Figures  
Figure B-1  
Figure B-2  
Figure B-3  
Figure B-4  
Figure B-5  
Figure B-6  
System board layout (front) ...........................................................................B-1  
System board layout (back) ...........................................................................B-3  
Sound Board (FLGSN*) layout .....................................................................B-5  
Parallel port Board (FLGCP*) layout............................................................B-6  
Serial port Board (FLGSR*) layout...............................................................B-7  
S-Video Board (FLKCS*) layout ..................................................................B-8  
Figure E-1  
Figure E-2  
Keyboard layout (for UK)..............................................................................E-1  
Keyboard layout (for US) ..............................................................................E-1  
Figure F-1  
Figure F-2  
RGB monitor ID wraparound connector (15-pin to 15-pin)..........................F-1  
Parallel port wraparound connector...............................................................F-1  
Tables  
Table B-1  
Table B-2  
Table B-3  
Table B-4  
Table B-5  
Table B-6  
System board ICs and connectors (front).......................................................B-2  
System board ICs and connectors (back).......................................................B-4  
Sound Board (FLGSN*) connectors..............................................................B-5  
Parallel port Board (FLGCP*) connectors.....................................................B-6  
Serial port Board (FLGSR*) connectors........................................................B-7  
S-Video Board (FLKCS*) connectors...........................................................B-8  
Table C-1  
Table C-2  
Table C-3  
Table C-4  
Table C-5  
Table C-6  
Table C-7  
Table C-8  
Memory 0 connector pin assignment (200-pin) ............................................C-1  
Memory 1 connector pin assignment (200-pin).............................................C-5  
HDD I/F connector pin assignment (44-pin) .................................................C-8  
Optical drive I/F connector pin assignment (50-pin).....................................C-9  
PC card I/F connector pin assignment (70-pin)...........................................C-10  
Docking I/F connector (240-pin) .................................................................C-12  
Mini PCI I/F connector pin assignment (124-pin).......................................C-16  
MDC I/F connector pin assignment (12-pin)...............................................C-18  
App-vi  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Table C-9  
Debug port connector pin assignment (12-pin) ...........................................C-18  
Table C-10 Keyboard I/F connector pin assignment (34-pin)........................................C-19  
Table C-11 Touch pad I/F connector pin assignment (4-pin).........................................C-19  
Table C-12 Switch board I/F connector pin assignment (10-pin)...................................C-20  
Table C-13 FLGCP/FLGSR board I/F connector pin assignment (30-pin)....................C-20  
Table C-14 Network I/F connector pin assignment (14-pin)..........................................C-21  
Table C-15 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin).....................................C-21  
Table C-16 USB I/F connector pin assignment (4-pin).................................................C-21  
Table C-17 LCD I/F connector pin assignment (41-pin)................................................C-22  
Table C-18 RGB I/F connector pin assignment (15-pin)................................................C-23  
Table C-19 S-Video I/F connector pin assignment (5-pin).............................................C-23  
Table C-20 Speaker connector (left) pin assignment (3-pin)..........................................C-23  
Table C-21 Speaker connector (right) pin assignment (2-pin) .......................................C-24  
Table C-22 Sound Board I/F connector pin assignment (18-pin)...................................C-24  
Table C-23 DC-IN connector pin assignment (4-pin) ....................................................C-24  
Table C-24 1st Battery connector pin assignment (10-pin)............................................C-25  
Table C-25 RTC Battery connector pin assignment (3-pin)...........................................C-25  
Table C-26 FAN I/F connector pin assignment (4-pin)..................................................C-25  
Table C-27 External Microphone Connector pin assignment (6-pin).............................C-26  
Table C-28 Headphone Connector pin assignment (6-pin) ............................................C-26  
Table C-29 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (18-pin).................................C-26  
Table C-30 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (10-pin).................................C-27  
Table C-31 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (30-pin).................................C-28  
Table C-32 Parallel I/F Connector pin assignment (25-pin)...........................................C-29  
Table C-33 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin).....................................C-29  
Table C-34 USB I/F Connector 1 pin assignment (4-pin) ..............................................C-29  
Table C-35 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin).....................................C-30  
Table C-36 USB I/F Connector 1 pin assignment (4-pin) ..............................................C-30  
Table C-37 USB I/F Connector 2 pin assignment (4-pin) ..............................................C-30  
Table C-38 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (5-pin)...................................C-31  
Table C-39 S-Video Connector pin assignment (4-pin) .................................................C-31  
Table C-40 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (30-pin).................................C-32  
Satellite A50S /TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
App-vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Table C-41 Serial I/F Connector pin assignment (9-pin)................................................C-33  
Table C-42 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin).....................................C-33  
Table C-43 USB I/F Connector 1 pin assignment (4-pin) ..............................................C-33  
Table D-1  
Table D-2  
Table D-3  
Table D-4  
Table D-5  
Table D-6  
Table D-7  
Scan codes (set 1 and set 2) .......................................................................... D-1  
Scan codes with left Shift key....................................................................... D-5  
Scan codes in Numlock mode....................................................................... D-6  
Scan codes with Fn key................................................................................. D-6  
Scan codes in overlay mode.......................................................................... D-7  
No.124 key scan code ................................................................................... D-7  
No.126 key scan code ................................................................................... D-8  
Table H-1  
MTBF............................................................................................................ H-1  
App-viii  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. A Handling the LCD Module  
Appendices  
Appendix. A  
Appendix A Handling the LCD Module  
Precautions for handling the LCD module  
The LCD module can be easily damaged during assembly or disassembly. Observe the  
following precautions when handling the LCD module:  
1. When installing the LCD module in the LCD cover, be sure to seat it so that it is  
properly aligned and maximum visibility of the display is maintained.  
2. Be careful to align the holes at the four corners of the LCD module with the  
corresponding holes in the LCD cover before securing the module with screws.  
Do not force the module into place, because stress can affect its performance.  
Also, the panel’s polarized surface is easily scarred, so be careful when handling it.  
Satellite A50 S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
A-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. A Handling the LCD Module  
3. If the panel’s surface gets dirty, wipe it with cotton or a soft cloth. If it is still dirty,  
try breathing on the surface to create a light condensate and wipe it again.  
If the surface is very dirty, we recommend a CRT cleaning agent. Apply the agent to  
a cloth and then wipe the panel’s surface. Do not apply cleanser directly to the panel.  
4. If water or other liquid is left on the panel’s surface for a long period, it can change  
the screen’s tint or stain it. Be sure to quickly wipe off any liquid.  
A-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. A Handling the LCD Module  
Appendices  
5. Glass is used in the panel, so be careful not to drop it or let it strike a hard object,  
which could cause breakage or cracks.  
6. CMOS-LSI circuits are used in the module, so guard against damage from  
electrostatic discharge. Be sure to wear a wrist or ankle ground when handling the  
module.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
A-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. A Handling the LCD Module  
7. Do not expose the module to direct sunlight or strong ultraviolet rays for long periods.  
8. Do not store the module at temperatures below specifications. Cold can cause the  
liquid crystals to freeze, lose their elasticity or otherwise suffer damage.  
9. Do not disassemble the LCD module. Disassembly can cause malfunctions.  
A-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. A Handling the LCD Module  
Appendices  
10. If you transport the module, do not use packing material that contains epoxy resin  
(amine) or silicon glue (alcohol or oxime). These materials can release gas that can  
damage the panel’s polarization.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
A-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. A Handling the LCD Module  
A-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
Appendices  
Appendix. B  
Appendix B Board Layout  
B.1  
System Board Front View  
(c)  
(b)  
(a)  
(d)  
(e)  
(f)  
(g)  
(h)  
(i)  
(j)  
(k)  
(l)  
(m)  
(n)  
Figure B-1 System board layout (front)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
B-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
Table B-1 System board ICs and connectors (front)  
Mark  
Number  
CN8770  
CN5000  
CN3280  
PJ3502  
CN3240  
CN3200  
CN3290  
IC1600  
Name  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
(f)  
Fan cable I/F connector  
LCD harness connector  
Membrane SW I/F connector  
FLGCP*/FLGSR* I/F connector  
Touch pad connector  
Keybaord connector  
(g)  
(h)  
(i)  
Debuging port connector  
ICH6-M  
CN6002  
CN6001  
CN9500  
CN1800  
IS2110  
Speaker(R) cable connector  
Speaker(L) cable connector  
FLGSN* I/F connector  
HDD I/F connector  
(j)  
(k)  
(l)  
(m)  
(n)  
PC card I/F connector  
Card Controller  
IC2000  
B-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
Appendices  
B.2  
System Board Back View  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
(f)  
(g)  
(n)  
(h)  
(i)  
(m)  
(l)  
(k)  
(j)  
Figure B-2 System board layout (back)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
B-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
Table B-2 System board ICs and connectors (back)  
Mark  
Number  
CN8800  
CN2300  
CN8020  
CN9990  
CN3011  
CN4100  
IS1050  
Name  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
(f)  
DC-IN connector  
Docking I/F connector  
Battery I/F connector  
RTC battery connector  
Modem harness I/F connector  
Network I/F connector  
CPU  
(g)  
(h)  
(i)  
CN5620  
CN4610  
CN2220  
CN1410  
CN1400  
CN1810  
CN3010  
RGB I/F connector  
USB port  
(j)  
Mini PCI I/F connector  
Memory I/F connector (slot B)  
Memory I/F connector (slot A)  
Optical drive I/F connector  
MDC I/F connector  
(k)  
(l)  
(m)  
(n)  
B-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
Appendices  
B.3  
Sound Board (FLGSN*)  
(Front)  
(a)  
(Back)  
(b)  
(c)  
Figure B-3 Sound Board (FLGSN*) layout  
Table B-3 Sound Board (FLGSN*) connectors  
Mark  
(a)  
Number  
CN9510  
J6310  
Name  
System board I/F connector  
Headphone connector  
(b)  
(c)  
J6070  
External microphone connector  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
B-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
B.4  
Parallel port Board (FLGCP*)  
(a)  
(b)  
(d)  
(c)  
Figure B-4 Parallel port Board (FLGCP*) layout  
Table B-4 Parallel port Board (FLGCP*) connectors  
Mark  
Number  
CN4613  
CN4622  
CN3503  
CN4620  
Name  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
Parallel port  
USB connector  
System board I/F connector  
USB harness connector  
B-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
Appendices  
B.5  
Serial port Board (FLGSR*)  
(a)  
(b)  
(d)  
(c)  
Figure B-5 Serial port Board (FLGSR*) layout  
Table B-5 Serial port Board (FLGSR*) connectors  
Mark  
(a)  
Number  
CN3440  
CN4632  
CN3504  
CN4630  
Name  
Serial port  
(b)  
USB connector  
(c)  
System board I/F connector  
USB harness connector  
(d)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
B-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. B Board Layout  
B.6  
S-Video Board (FLKCS*)  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
Figure B-6 S-Video Board (FLKCS*) layout  
Table B-6 S-Video Board (FLKCS*) connectors  
Mark  
Number  
PJ5641  
PJ4611  
PJ4610  
PJ4612  
PJ5640  
Name  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
S-Video connector  
USB connector  
USB harness connector  
USB connector  
S-Video harness connector  
B-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Appendix. C  
Appendix C Pin Assignment  
System Board (FLKSY*)  
C.1  
CN1400 Memory 0 Connector (200-pin)  
Table C-1 Memory 0 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (1/4)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal name  
MRVREF-B0V  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
-
3
-
4
ADQ04-B1P  
ADQ05-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
5
ADQ00-B1P  
ADQ01-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
6
7
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
ADM0-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
ADQS0-B1N  
ADQS0-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ02-B1P  
ADQ07-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ03-B1P  
ADQ06-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ12-B1P  
ADQ13-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ08-B1P  
ADQ09-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADM1-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
ADQS1-B1N  
ADQS1-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
MCK0-B1P  
MCK0-B1N  
GND  
O
O
-
ADQ15-B1P  
ADQ14-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ10-B1P  
ADQ11-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
ADQ16-B1P  
ADQ17-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
ADQ20-B1P  
ADQ21-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
-
ADQS2-B1N  
ADQS2-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
NC  
-
ADM2-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Table C-1 Memory 0 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (2/4)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
ADQ23-B1P  
ADQ22-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
56  
Signal Name  
ADQ19-B1P  
ADQ18-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
55  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
ADQ24-B1P  
ADQ25-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
62  
ADQ29-B1P  
ADQ28-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
ADM3-B1P  
NC  
I/O  
-
68  
ADQS3-B1N  
ADQS3-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
69  
70  
71  
GND  
-
72  
73  
ADQ27-B1P  
ADQ26-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
74  
ADQ30-B1P  
ADQ31-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
MCKE0-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
-
80  
MCKE1-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
-
81  
82  
83  
NC  
-
84  
NC  
-
85  
ABS2-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
-
86  
NC  
-
87  
88  
1R8-B1V  
-
89  
AMA12-B1P  
AMA09-B1P  
AMA08-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
O
O
-
90  
AMA11-B1P  
AMA07-B1P  
AMA06-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
O
O
I
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
AMA05-B1P  
AMA03-B1P  
AMA01-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
O
O
-
98  
AMA04-B1P  
AMA02-B1P  
AMA00-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
O
O
-
99  
100  
102  
104  
106  
108  
110  
112  
114  
116  
118  
120  
101  
103  
105  
107  
109  
111  
113  
115  
117  
119  
AMA10-B1P  
ABS0-B1P  
AWE-B1N  
1R8-B1V  
O
O
I
ABS1-B1P  
ARAS-B1N  
MCS0-B1N  
1R8-B1V  
O
I
O
-
-
ACAS-B1N  
ACS3-B1N  
1R8-B1V  
O
O
-
MODT2-B1P  
AMA13-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
O
I/O  
-
MODT1-B1P  
O
NC  
-
C-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Table C-1 Memory 0 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (3/4)  
Pin No.  
121  
123  
125  
127  
129  
131  
133  
135  
137  
139  
141  
143  
145  
147  
149  
151  
153  
155  
157  
159  
161  
163  
165  
167  
169  
171  
173  
175  
177  
179  
181  
183  
185  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
122  
124  
126  
128  
130  
132  
134  
136  
138  
140  
142  
144  
146  
148  
150  
152  
154  
156  
158  
160  
162  
164  
166  
168  
170  
172  
174  
176  
178  
180  
182  
184  
186  
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
-
ADQ32-B1P  
ADQ33-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ36-B1P  
ADQ37-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQS4-B1N  
ADQS4-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADM4-B1P  
GND  
O
-
ADQ38-B1P  
ADQ35-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ34-B1P  
ADQ39-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ40-B1P  
ADQ44-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ45-B1P  
ADQ41-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQS5-B1N  
ADQS5-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADM5-B1P  
GND  
O
-
ADQ42-B1P  
ADQ43-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ46-B1P  
ADQ47-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ48-B1P  
ADQ49-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ52-B1P  
ADQ53-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
NC  
-
MCK1-B1P  
MCK1-B1N  
GND  
O
GND  
-
O
ADQS6-B1N  
ADQS6-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
-
ADM6-B1P  
GND  
O
-
ADQ55-B1P  
ADQ51-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ54-B1P  
ADQ50-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ56-B1P  
ADQ57-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADQ60-B1P  
ADQ61-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ADM7-B1P  
O
ADQS7-B1N  
I/O  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Table C-1 Memory 0 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (4/4)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
188  
Signal Name  
ADQS7-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
187  
189  
191  
193  
195  
197  
199  
ADQ58-B1P  
ADQ59-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
190  
192  
ADQ62-B1P  
ADQ63-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
194  
SMBDAT-P3P  
SMBCL2-P3P  
P3V  
I/O  
I/O  
-
196  
198  
GND  
-
200  
GND  
-
C-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.2  
CN1410 Memory 1 Connector (200-pin)  
Table C-2 Memory 1 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (1/4)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal name  
MR0EF-B0V  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
-
3
-
4
BDQ05-B1P  
BDQ04-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
5
BDQ07-B1P  
BDQ06-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
6
7
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
58  
60  
62  
BDM0-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
55  
57  
59  
61  
BDQS0-B1N  
BDQS0-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ01-B1P  
BDQ00-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ03-B1P  
BDQ02-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ12-B1P  
BDQ13-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ11-B1P  
BDQ08-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDM1-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
BDQS1-B1N  
BDQS1-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
MCK3-B1P  
MCK3-B1N  
GND  
O
O
-
BDQ09-B1P  
BDQ14-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ15-B1P  
BDQ10-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
BDQ16-B1P  
BDQ18-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
BDQ21-B1P  
BDQ17-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
-
BDQS2-B1N  
BDQS2-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
NC  
-
BDM2-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
-
BDQ23-B1P  
BDQ22-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ19-B1P  
BDQ20-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ30-B1P  
I/O  
BDQ24-B1P  
I/O  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Table C-2 Memory 1 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (2/4)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
BDQ28-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
64  
Signal Name  
BDQ25-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
63  
65  
66  
67  
BDM3-B1P  
NC  
I/O  
-
68  
BDQS3-B1N  
BDQS3-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
69  
70  
71  
GND  
-
72  
73  
BDQ26-B1P  
BDQ27-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
74  
BDQ29-B1P  
BDQ31-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
75  
76  
77  
78  
79  
MCKE2-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
NC  
O
-
80  
MCKE3-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
NC  
O
-
81  
82  
83  
-
84  
-
85  
BBS2-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
BMA12-B1P  
BMA09-B1P  
BMA08-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
BMA05-B1P  
BMA03-B1P  
BMA01-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
BMA10-B1P  
BBS0-B1P  
BWE-B1N  
1R8-B1V  
BCAS-B1N  
MCS3-B1N  
1R8-B1V  
MODT3-B1P  
GND  
O
-
86  
NC  
-
87  
88  
1R8-B1V  
BMA11-B1P  
BMA07-B1P  
BMA06-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
BMA04-B1P  
BMA02-B1P  
BMA00-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
BBS1-B1P  
BRAS-B1N  
MCS2-B1N  
1R8-B1V  
MODT2-B1P  
BMA13-B1P  
1R8-B1V  
NC  
-
89  
O
O
O
-
90  
O
O
O
I
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
O
O
O
-
98  
O
O
O
-
99  
100  
102  
104  
106  
108  
110  
112  
114  
116  
118  
120  
122  
124  
126  
128  
101  
103  
105  
107  
109  
111  
113  
115  
117  
119  
121  
123  
125  
127  
O
O
I
O
I
O
-
-
O
O
-
O
I/O  
-
O
-
-
GND  
-
BDQ32-B1P  
BDQ33-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ36-B1P  
BDQ37-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
C-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Table C-2 Memory 1 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (3/4)  
Pin No.  
129  
131  
133  
135  
137  
139  
141  
143  
145  
147  
149  
151  
153  
155  
157  
159  
161  
163  
165  
167  
169  
171  
173  
175  
177  
179  
181  
Signal name  
BDQS4-B1N  
BDQS4-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
130  
132  
134  
136  
138  
140  
142  
144  
146  
148  
150  
152  
154  
156  
158  
160  
162  
164  
166  
168  
170  
172  
174  
176  
178  
180  
182  
Signal Name  
BDM4-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
O
-
BDQ38-B1P  
BDQ39-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ34-B1P  
BDQ35-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ44-B1P  
BDQ45-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ40-B1P  
BDQ41-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQS5-B1N  
BDQS5-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDM5-B1P  
GND  
O
-
BDQ43-B1P  
BDQ42-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ46-B1P  
BDQ47-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ48-B1P  
BDQ54-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ52-B1P  
BDQ53-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
NC  
-
MCK1-B1P  
MCK1-B1N  
GND  
O
GND  
-
O
BDQS6-B1N  
BDQS6-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
-
BDM6-B1P  
GND  
O
-
BDQ51-B1P  
BDQ55-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ50-B1P  
BDQ49-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ57-B1P  
BDQ60-B1P  
I/O  
I/O  
BDQ56-B1P  
BDQ61-B1P  
I/O  
I/O  
183  
185  
187  
189  
191  
193  
GND  
-
O
-
184  
186  
188  
190  
192  
194  
GND  
-
BDM7-B1P  
GND  
BDQS7-B1N  
BDQS7-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ58-B1P  
BDQ59-B1P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
BDQ62-B1P  
BDQ63-B1P  
I/O  
I/O  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Table C-2 Memory 1 connector pin assignment (200-pin) (4/4)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
SMBDAT-P3P  
SMBCL2-P3P  
P3V  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
196  
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
195  
197  
199  
-
-
-
198  
GND  
200  
P3V  
C.3  
CN1800 HDD I/F Connector (44-pin)  
Table C-3 HDD I/F connector pin assignment (44-pin)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal Name  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
3
P5V  
I
4
P5V  
I
5
GND  
-
6
HDDLED-P5N  
SODCS1-P3N  
SODA0-P3P  
SODA1-P3P  
IRQ14-P3P  
I/O  
O
7
SODCS3-SO3N  
SODA2-SO3SO  
N.C.  
O
O
-
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
O
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
O
N.C.  
-
I
GND  
-
SODDACK-P3N  
SOIORDY-P3P  
SODIOR-P3N  
SODIOW-P3N  
SODDREQ-P3P  
GND  
O
GND  
-
I
GND  
-
O
GND  
-
O
GND  
-
I
N.C.  
-
-
SODD15-P3P  
SODD14-P3P  
SODD13-P3P  
SODD12-P3P  
SODD11-P3P  
SODD10-P3P  
SODD09-P3P  
SODD08-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
SODD00-P3P  
SODD01-P3P  
SODD02-P3P  
SODD03-P3P  
SODD04-P3P  
SODD05-P3P  
SODD06-P3P  
SODD07-P3P  
SORSTA-P3N  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
C-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.4  
CN1810 Optical Drive I/F Connector (50-pin)  
Table C-4 Optical drive I/F connector pin assignment (50-pin)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal name  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
3
GND  
-
4
N.C.  
-
5
RSTIDB-E3P  
PDD07-P3P  
PDD06-P3P  
PDD05-P3P  
PDD04-P3P  
PDD03-P3P  
PDD02-P3P  
PDD01-P3P  
PDD00-P3P  
GND  
O
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
6
PDD08-P3P  
PDD09-P3P  
PDD10-P3P  
PDD11-P3P  
PDD12-P3P  
PDD13-P3P  
PDD14-P3P  
PDD15-P3P  
PDDREQ-P3P  
PDIOR-P3N  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
7
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
O
-
PDIOW-P3N  
PIORDY-P3P  
IDEIRQ-P3P  
PDA1-P3P  
PDA0-P3P  
PDCS1-P3N  
N.C.  
O
I
PDDACK-P3N  
N.C.  
O
-
I
O
O
O
-
N.C.  
-
PDA2-P3P  
PDCS3-P3N  
P5V  
O
O
O
O
O
-
P5V  
O
O
-
P5V  
P5V  
P5V  
GND  
GND  
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.5  
IS2110 PC Card I/F Connector (70-pin)  
Table C-5 PC card I/F connector pin assignment (70-pin) (1/2)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
ACAD00-PYP  
ACAD03-PYP  
ACAD07-PYP  
ACAD09-PYP  
ACAD12-PYP  
ACCBE1-PYN  
ACPERR-PYN  
ACINT-PYN  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
O
1
3
ACAD01-PYP  
ACAD05-PYP  
ACCBE0-PYN  
ACAD11-PYP  
ACAD14-PYP  
ACPAR-PYP  
ACGNT-PYN  
MCVCCA-PYV  
ACCLK-PYP  
ACCBE2-PYN  
ACAD20-PYP  
ACAD22-PYP  
ACAD24-PYP  
ACAD26-PYP  
ACAD29-PYP  
ACCLKR-PYN  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
58  
60  
62  
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
55  
57  
59  
61  
I
MCVPPA-EYV  
ACIRDY-PYN  
ACAD18-PYP  
ACAD21-PYP  
ACAD23-PYP  
ACAD25-PYP  
ACAD27-PYP  
ACD02-PYP  
GND  
I
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
ACCD1-E3N  
ACAD04-PYP  
ACD14-PYP  
ACAD10-PYP  
ACAD13-PYP  
ACAD16-PYP  
ACLOCK-PYN  
ACDEVS-PYN  
MCVPPA-PYV  
ACFRAM-PYN  
ACAD19-PYP  
ACRST-PYN  
ACREQ-PYN  
ACAUDI-PYP  
O
ACAD02-PYP  
ACAD06-PYP  
ACAD08-PYP  
ACVS1-P3P  
ACAD15-PYP  
ACA18-PYP  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
ACSTOP-PYN  
MCVCCA-PYV  
ACTRDY-PYN  
ACAD17-PYP  
ACVS2-P3P  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
O
ACSERR-PYN  
ACCBE3-PYN  
O
C-10  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Table C-5 PC Card slot connector pin assignment (70-pin)(2/2)  
Pin No.  
63  
Signal name  
ACSTSC-PYP  
ACAD30-PYP  
ACCD2-P3N  
GND  
I/O  
O
Pin No.  
64  
Signal Name  
ACAD28-PYP  
ACAD31-PYP  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
65  
I/O  
O
66  
67  
68  
69  
-
70  
GND  
-
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.6  
CN2300 Docking I/F connector (240-pin)  
Table C-6 Docking I/F connector (240-pin)(1/4)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
DSKDC  
I/O  
Pin No.  
A2  
2
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
A1  
1
I
I
-
DCOUT  
DCOUT  
I
3
DOCDT1-S3N  
EXMSCK-P5P  
GND  
O
I/O  
-
4
P5V  
I
5
6
EXKBCK-P5P  
N.C.  
I/O  
7
8
-
9
DPCONF-S5P  
GND  
O
-
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
58  
GND  
-
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
55  
57  
DDCACK-P3P  
DGREEN-PXP  
DVSYNC-P3P  
Reserved  
I/O  
DRED-PXP  
DBLUE-PXP  
(DVISC-P3P)  
GND  
I
I
I
I
-
-
-
(DVI-PRTCT2)  
(DVITX2-P3P)  
(DVITX1-P3P)  
(DVITX0-P3P)  
GND  
-
(DVI-PRTCT1)  
(DVITX2-P3N)  
(DVITX1-P3N)  
(DVITX0-P3N)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(DVITXC-P3P)  
(DVIDET-S3N)  
Reserved  
-
(DVITXC-P3N)  
(DVIPD1-P3N)  
(QSWON-B3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
-
(DIRQD-S3N)  
(PCM2SP-B3P)  
(DAD00-P3P)  
(DAD00-P3P)  
(DAD06-P3P)  
(XDPCI-P3P)  
(DAD11-P3P)  
(DAD11-P3P)  
(DINTA-P3N)  
VOID  
-
-
-
(DPMRST-S3N)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DADO2-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD09-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD15-P3P)  
VOID  
-
-
-
-
BIDDP-EXP  
VOID  
I/O  
-
BIDDN-EXN  
VOID  
I/O  
-
C-12  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Table C-6 Docking I/F connector (240-pin)(2/4)  
Pin No.  
59  
Signal name  
MDMRNG-E3P  
DCOUT  
I/O  
Pin No.  
60  
Signal name  
MDMTIP-E3P  
DCOUT  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
61  
I
62  
I
I
63  
EJCTRQ-S3N  
EXMSDT-P5P  
GND  
I/O  
64  
IF-P5V  
65  
I/O  
-
66  
EXKBDT-P5P  
(DNVSON-S3P)  
(NVPCNF-S3P)  
DDCADA-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
-
67  
68  
69  
GND  
-
70  
-
71  
GND  
-
72  
I/O  
-
73  
GND  
-
74  
75  
GND  
-
76  
DHSYNC-P3P  
(DVI_PRTCT3)  
(DVITX5-P3P)  
(DVITX4-P3P)  
(DVITX3-P3P)  
(DVI16)  
I
77  
(DVISD-P3P)  
GND  
-
78  
-
79  
-
80  
-
81  
(DVITX5-P3N)  
(DVITX4-P3N)  
(DVITX3-P3N)  
(DVI17)  
-
82  
-
83  
-
84  
-
85  
-
86  
-
87  
-
88  
GND  
-
89  
GND  
-
90  
(DOC_ON_LED1)  
(DOC_ON_LED2)  
(DVI_PRTCT4)  
(DSMI-B3P)  
(DCKRUN-P3N)  
(DAD01-P3P)  
(DAD03-P3P)  
(DAD07-P3P)  
(DAD08-P3P)  
(DAD10-P3P)  
(DAD14-P3P)  
(DPAR-P3P)  
VOID  
-
91  
Reserved  
(DVIPD0-P3N)  
(DCADIO-S3P)  
GND  
-
92  
-
93  
-
94  
-
95  
-
96  
-
97  
-
98  
-
99  
(PME-S3P)  
GND  
100  
102  
104  
106  
108  
110  
112  
114  
116  
118  
120  
-
101  
103  
105  
107  
109  
111  
113  
115  
117  
119  
-
-
(DAD05-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD10-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DCBE1-P3N)  
VOID  
-
-
-
-
BIDCN-EXN  
BIDCP-EXP  
VOID  
I/O  
I/O  
-
VOID  
-
VOID  
-
VOID  
-
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Table C-6 Docking I/F connector (240-pin)(3/4)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
DCOUT  
I/O  
Pin No.  
122  
124  
126  
128  
130  
132  
134  
136  
138  
140  
142  
144  
146  
148  
150  
152  
154  
156  
158  
160  
162  
164  
166  
168  
170  
172  
174  
176  
178  
180  
Signal name  
DCOUT  
I/O  
121  
123  
125  
127  
129  
131  
133  
135  
137  
139  
141  
143  
145  
147  
149  
151  
153  
155  
157  
159  
161  
163  
165  
167  
169  
171  
173  
175  
177  
179  
I
I
DSSCL-S5P  
M5V  
I/O  
IF-P5V  
I
I
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
I
N.C.  
-
SNDMUT-S3N  
DOUTL-PXP  
DINR-PXN  
PWRSW-S3N  
DSR-PYP  
RING-BYP  
PDB07-P5P  
GND  
(SNDVCC-OFF)  
DINL-PXP  
GND  
-
I/O  
I/O  
O
O
O
I/O  
-
I/O  
-
DCD-PYP  
TXD-PYN  
PE-P5P  
O
I
O
PDB06-P5P  
GND  
I/O  
-
PDB04-P5P  
PDB02-P5P  
STROB-P5N  
(DAD30-P3P)  
(DAD28-P3P)  
(DAD24-P3P)  
(DIDSL-P3P)  
(DAD20-P3P)  
(DCBE0-P3N)  
(DAD16-P3P)  
(DCBE2-P3N)  
(DSTOP-P3N)  
VOID  
I/O  
I/O  
I
PDB01-P5P  
PDB00-P5P  
(DPGNT-P3N)  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I
-
-
-
(DAD26-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD22-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD18-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DTRDY-P3N)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
LAN-E3V  
VOID  
I
VOID  
-
-
N.C.  
-
BIDAP-EXP  
O
BIDAN-EXN  
O
C-14  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Table C-6 Docking I/F connector (240-pin)(4/4)  
Pin No.  
181  
183  
185  
187  
189  
191  
193  
195  
197  
199  
201  
203  
205  
207  
209  
211  
213  
215  
217  
219  
221  
223  
225  
227  
229  
231  
233  
235  
237  
239  
Signal name  
DCOUT  
I/O  
Pin No.  
182  
184  
186  
188  
190  
192  
194  
196  
198  
200  
202  
204  
206  
208  
210  
212  
214  
216  
218  
220  
222  
224  
226  
228  
230  
232  
234  
236  
238  
240  
Signal name  
DCOUT  
I/O  
I
I
I
DSSDA-S5P  
Reserved  
GND  
I/O  
IF-P5V  
-
N.C.  
-
-
N.C.  
-
USBP2-S3P  
GND  
I/O  
USBP2-S3N  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
-
N.C.  
-
DOUTR-PXP  
DOUTL-PXN  
DINR-PXP  
RXD-PYN  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
O
O
O
O
-
DOUTR-PXN  
DINL-PXN  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
I
RTS-PYP  
DTR-PYP  
BUSY-P5P  
PDB05-P5P  
GND  
CTS-PYP  
I
SELCT-P5P  
ACK-P5N  
O
I/O  
-
GND  
PDB03-P5P  
PINIT-P5N  
AUTFD-P5N  
(DAD31-P3P)  
(DAD29-P3P)  
(DAD25-P3P)  
(DCBE23-P3N)  
(DAD21-P3P)  
(DCPCLR-P3P)  
(DAD17-P3P)  
(DFRAME-P3N)  
(DDEVSL-P3N)  
ACT-E3N  
I/O  
I
SLIN-P5N  
ERROR-P5N  
(DPREQ-P3N)  
GND  
I
O
-
I
-
-
-
(DAD27-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD23-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DAD19-P3P)  
GND  
-
-
-
-
(DIRDY-P3N)  
GND  
-
-
-
O
O
-
LINK-E3N  
VOID  
O
-
DOCDT2-S3N  
VOID  
BIDBP-EXP  
I
BIDBN-EXN  
I
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.7  
CN2200 Mini PCI I/F Connector (124-pin)  
Table C-7 Mini PCI I/F connector pin assignment (124-pin) (1/2)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
N.C.  
I/O  
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
N.C.  
I/O  
1
-
-
3
N.C.  
-
4
N.C.  
-
-
5
N.C.  
-
6
N.C.  
7
N.C.  
-
-
8
N.C.  
-
9
N.C.  
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
58  
60  
62  
N.C.  
-
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
55  
57  
59  
61  
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
WLON-S3N  
GND  
I
N.C.  
-
-
N.C.  
-
PIRQD-P3N  
P3V  
I/O  
I
P5V  
I
PIRQG-P3N  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
E3V  
I
X33MPC-P3P  
GND  
O
-
PCIRS0-S3N  
P3V  
O
I
PREQ2-P3N  
P3V  
I
PGNT2-P3N  
GND  
O
-
I
AD31-P3P  
AD29-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
PME-S3N  
N.C.  
I
-
AD30-P3P  
P3V  
I/O  
I
AD27-P3P  
AD25-P3P  
N.C.  
I/O  
I/O  
-
AD28-P3P  
AD26-P3P  
AD24-P3P  
AD26-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
CBE3-P3N  
AD23-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
AD21-P3P  
AD19-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
AD22-P3P  
AD20-P3P  
PAR-P3P  
AD18-P3P  
AD16-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
AD17-P3P  
CBE2-P3N  
IRDY-P3N  
I/O  
I
I/O  
C-16  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Table C-7 Mini PCI I/F connector pin assignment (124-pin) (2/2)  
Pin No.  
63  
Signal name  
P3V  
I/O  
Pin No.  
64  
Signal Name  
FRAME-P3N  
TRDY-P3N  
STOP-P3N  
P3V  
I/O  
I
I/O  
65  
CLKRUN-P3N  
SERR-P3N  
GND  
O
66  
I/O  
67  
I
68  
I/O  
69  
-
70  
I
71  
PERR-P3N  
CBE1-P3N  
AD14-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
72  
DEVSEL-P3N  
GND  
I/O  
73  
I
74  
-
75  
I/O  
76  
AD15-P3P  
AD13-P3P  
AD11-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
77  
-
78  
I/O  
79  
AD12-P3P  
AD10-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
80  
I/O  
81  
I/O  
82  
-
83  
-
84  
AD09-P3P  
CBE0-P3N  
P3V  
I/O  
85  
AD08-P3P  
AD07-P3P  
P3V  
I/O  
86  
O
87  
I/O  
88  
i
89  
i
90  
AD06-P3P  
AD04-P3P  
AD02-P3P  
AD00-P3P  
N.C.  
I/O  
91  
AD05-P3P  
N.C.  
I/O  
92  
I/O  
93  
-
94  
I/O  
95  
AD03-P3P  
P5V  
I/O  
96  
I/O  
-
97  
-
I/O  
-
98  
99  
AD01-P3P  
GND  
100  
102  
104  
106  
108  
110  
112  
114  
116  
118  
120  
122  
124  
N.C.  
-
101  
103  
105  
107  
109  
111  
113  
115  
117  
119  
121  
123  
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
E3V  
I
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.8  
CN3010 MDC I/F Connector (12-pin)  
Table C-8 MDC I/F connector pin assignment (12-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
Reserved  
Reserved  
E3V  
I/O  
1
3
-
I/O  
-
2
4
-
-
-
-
-
I
M97OT2-P3P  
GND  
5
6
7
M97SY2-P3P  
M97IN2-E3P  
-M97RS2-P3P  
I
8
GND  
9
I/O  
I
10  
12  
GND  
11  
X97BC2-P3P  
C.9  
CN3490 Debug Port Connector (12-pin)  
Table C-9 Debug port connector pin assignment (12-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
P3V  
I/O  
-
1
3
-
2
4
LPCFRM-P3N  
LAD0-P3P  
LAD2-P3P  
PLTRS1-E3N  
P3V  
DBGDET-P3N  
LAD1-P3P  
LAD3-P3P  
X33DBG-P3P  
GND  
O
I/O  
I/O  
I
5
I/O  
I/O  
I
6
7
8
9
10  
12  
11  
-
-
C-18  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.10  
CN3200 Keyboard I/F Connector (34-pin)  
Table C-10 Keyboard I/F connector pin assignment (34-pin)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal name  
NUMLED-P5N  
CAPLED-P5N  
KBSC00-S3N  
KBSC02-S3N  
KBSC04-S3N  
KBSC06-S3N  
KBSC07-S3N  
KBSC09-S3N  
KBRT02-S3N  
KBSC10-S3N  
KBRT04-S3N  
KBSC12-S3N  
KBRT06-S3N  
KBSC14-S3N  
P5V  
I/O  
I
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
ARWLED-P5N  
P5V  
I/O  
I
3
I
4
I
5
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
I
6
KBSC01-S3N  
KBSC03-S3N  
KBSC05-S3N  
KBRT00-S3N  
KBSC08-S3N  
KBRT01-S3N  
KBRT03-S3N  
KBSC11-S3N  
KBRT05-S3N  
KBSC13-S3N  
KBRT07-S3N  
KBSC15-S3N  
N.C.  
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
O
-
7
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
P5V  
I
C.11  
CN3240 Touch Pad I/F Connector (4-pin)  
Table C-11 Touch pad I/F connector pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
P5V  
IPDCLK-P5P  
I/O  
I
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
IPDDAT-P5P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
1
3
2
4
I/O  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.12  
CN3280 Switch Board I/F Connector (10-pin)  
Table C-12 Switch board I/F connector pin assignment (10-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
-
1
3
5
7
9
2
4
GND  
-
GPBTND-S3N  
GPBTNB-S3N  
PWRSW-S3N  
PNLOFF-S3N  
O
O
O
O
GPBTNC-S3N  
GPBTNA-S3N  
GND  
O
O
-
6
8
10  
C.13  
CN3502 FLGCP/FLGSR Board I/F Connector (30-pin)  
Table C-13 FLGCP/FLGSR board I/F connector pin assignment (30-pin)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal Name  
P3V  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal name  
P3V  
I/O  
-
3
KRSSDM-P3N  
GND  
I/O  
-
4
PRTDET-P3N  
STROB-P5N  
BPDB01-P5P  
BPDB03-P5P  
BPDB05-P5P  
BPDB07-P5P  
GND  
I/O  
5
6
I
7
BPDB00-P5P  
BPDB02-P5P  
BPDB04-P5P  
BPDB06-P5P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
8
I/O  
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
I/O  
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
I/O  
I/O  
-
I
ACK-P5N  
PE-P5P  
I
BUSY-P5P  
SELCT-P5P  
ERROR-P5N  
SLIN-P5N  
GND  
I
I
AUTFD-P5N  
PINIT-P5N  
PRTDET-P3N  
GND  
O
O
I/O  
-
I
O
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
C-20  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.14  
CN4100 Network I/F Connector (14-pin)  
Table C-14 Network I/F connector pin assignment (14-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
ACT-E3N  
I/O  
I
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
LINK-E3N  
LAN-E3V  
I/O  
I
1
3
2
4
LAN-E3V  
I
I
5
N.C.  
-
6
N.C.  
-
7
BIDDN-EXN  
BIDCN-EXN  
BIDAP-EXP  
BIDBP-EXP  
I/O  
I/O  
I
8
BIDDP-EXP  
BIDCP-EXP  
BIDAN-EXN  
BIDBN-EXN  
I/O  
I/O  
I
9
10  
12  
14  
11  
13  
O
O
C.15  
CN4611 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)  
Table C-15 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USBP0-S3N  
USBOPS-E5V  
USBP3-S3N  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I
1
3
5
7
2
4
6
8
USBP0-S3P  
USBOPS-E5V  
USBP3-S3P  
I/O  
I
I/O  
-
I/O  
C.16  
CN4610 USB I/F Connector 0 (4-pin)  
Table C-16 USB I/F connector pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USB1PS-E5V  
USBP5-S3P  
I/O  
I
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USBP5-S3N  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
-
1
3
2
4
I/O  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.17  
CN5000 LCD I/F Connector (41-pin)  
Table C-17 LCD I/F connector pin assignment (41-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
-
1
3
TXDTA0-PYP  
TXDTA1-PYP  
GND  
I
4
TXDTA0-PYN  
TXDTA1-PYN  
TXDTA2-PYP  
TXCLKA-PYP  
GND  
O
O
I
5
I
6
7
-
8
9
TXDTA2-PYN  
TXCLKA-PYN  
TXDTB0-PYP  
TXDTB1-PYP  
GND  
O
O
I
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
I
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
31  
33  
35  
37  
39  
41  
-
TXDTB0-PYN  
TXDTB1-PYN  
TXDTB2-PYP  
TXCLKB-PYP  
GND  
O
O
I
I
-
TXDTB2-PYN  
TXCLKB-PYN  
GND  
O
O
-
I
-
N.C.  
-
PNL-P3V  
N.C.  
I
PNL-P3V  
GND  
I
-
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
N.C.  
-
FL-P5V  
I
FL-P5V  
I
FL-P5V  
I
PNL2-P3P  
PNL0-P3P  
BRT1-P5P  
GND  
O
O
I
PNL1-P3P  
BRT2DA-S3P  
BRT0-P5P  
O
I
I
-
C-22  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.18  
CN5620 RGB I/F Connector (15-pin)  
Table C-18 RGB I/F connector pin assignment (15-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
MRED-PXP  
MBLUE-PXP  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
MGREEN-PXP  
N.C.  
I/O  
1
3
I
2
4
I
-
I
5
-
-
6
GND  
-
7
GND  
8
GND  
-
9
DDC-P5V  
N.C.  
I
10  
12  
14  
GND  
-
11  
13  
15  
-
CRTSDA-P5P  
MVSYNC-P3P  
I/O  
I/O  
MHSYNC-P3P  
CRTSCL-P5P  
I/O  
I/O  
C.19  
CN5340 S-Video I/F Connector (5-pin)  
Table C-19 S-Video I/F connector pin assignment (5-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
CHROMA-PYP  
LUMINA-PYP  
I/O  
1
3
5
-
-
-
2
4
I
I
GND  
GND  
C.20  
CN6001 Speaker Connector (Left) (3-pin)  
Table C-20 Speaker connector (left) pin assignment (3-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
SPOUT (L-)  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
I/O  
N.C.  
1
3
I
I
2
-
SPOUT (L+)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C.21  
CN6002 Speaker Connector (Right) (2-pin)  
Table C-21 Speaker connector (right) pin assignment (2-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
I/O  
SPOUT(R+)  
SPOUT (R-)  
1
I
2
I
C.22  
CN9500 Sound Board I/F Connector (18-pin)  
Table C-22 Sound Board I/F connector pin assignment (18-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
A-GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
A-GND  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
-
I
A-GND  
-
LOUTL-PXP  
A4R7-P4V  
VROUTR-PXP  
A-GND  
5
VROUTL-PXP  
A4R7-P4V  
LOUTR-PXP  
HEADR-PXP  
SPKEN-P5P  
MICIN-PXP  
A-GND  
O
I
6
I
7
8
O
-
9
I
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
11  
13  
15  
17  
I
HEADL-PXP  
MMREFV-P2V  
A-GND  
I
O
O
-
O
-
A-GND  
-
C.23 CN8800 DC-IN Connector (4-pin)  
Table C-23 DC-IN connector pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
ADPDC  
I/O  
O
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
PVDC  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
O
O
PVH  
O
PVL  
C-24  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.24  
CN8020 1st Battery Connector (10-pin)  
Table C-24 1st Battery connector pin assignment (10-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
CHGVL  
DCHG  
I/O  
O
I
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
BTMP1  
I/O  
O
I
1
3
5
7
9
2
4
M5V  
PSCL-S5P  
GND  
O
-
6
PSDA-S5P  
DBT10V-S5N  
GND  
O
O
-
8
GND  
-
10  
C.25  
CN9990 RTC Battery Connector (3-pin)  
Table C-25 RTC Battery connector pin assignment (3-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
R3V  
GND  
I/O  
O
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
N.C.  
I/O  
1
3
2
-
C.26  
CN8770 FAN I/F Connector (4-pin)  
Table C-26 FAN I/F connector pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
P5V  
FANG0-P3P  
I/O  
I
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
-
I
O
FPWM0-S3P  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Sound Board (FLGSN*)  
C.27  
C.28  
C.29  
J6070 External Microphone Connector (6-pin)  
Table C-27 External Microphone Connector pin assignment (6-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
A-GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
MICIN-PXP  
A-GND  
I/O  
O
-
1
3
5
2
4
6
MMREFV  
N.C.  
O
-
MMREFV  
O
J6310 Headphone Connector (6-pin)  
Table C-28 Headphone Connector pin assignment (6-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
A-GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
HEADL-PXP  
A-GND  
I/O  
O
-
1
3
5
2
4
6
HEADR-PXP  
SPKEN-P5N  
O
O
N.C.  
-
CN9510 System Board I/F Connector (18-pin)  
Table C-29 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (18-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
A-GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
A-GND  
I/O  
-
1
3
2
4
A-GND  
-
MICIN-PXP  
SPKEN-P5N  
HEADR-PXP  
LOUTR-PXP  
A4R7-P4V  
VROUTL-PXP  
A-GND  
I
5
MMREFV-P2V  
HEADL-PXP  
A-GND  
I
6
I
7
O
-
8
O
O
O
I
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
11  
13  
15  
17  
VROUT-PXP  
A4R7-P4V  
LOUTL-PXP  
A-GND  
I
O
O
-
-
A-GND  
-
C-26  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
Switch Board (FLKSW*)  
C.30  
PJ3280 System Board I/F Connector (10-pin)  
Table C-30 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (10-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
1
3
5
7
9
-
-
I
2
4
-
I
I
I
I
GND  
GPBTND-S3N  
GPBTNB-S3N  
PWRSW-S3N  
PNLOFF-S3N  
GPBTNC-S3N  
GPBTNA-S3N  
GND  
6
I
8
-
10  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Parallel Board (FLGCP*)  
C.31  
CN3503 System Board I/F Connector (30-pin)  
Table C-31 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (30-pin)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal Name  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
2
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
-
-
-
3
N.C.  
4
GND  
5
GND  
-
6
STROB-P5N  
BPDB01-P5P  
BPDB03-P5P  
BPDB05-P5P  
BPDB07-P5P  
GND  
O
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
7
BPDB00-P5P  
BPDB02-P5P  
BPDB04-P5P  
BPDB06-P5P  
GND  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
8
9
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
ACK-P5N  
PE-P5P  
I
BUSY-P5P  
SELCT-P5P  
ERROR-P5N  
SLIN-P5N  
GND  
I
I
I
AUTFD-P5N  
PINIT-P5N  
(PRTDET#)  
GND  
O
O
-
I
O
-
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
C-28  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.32  
CN4613 Parallel I/F Connector (25-pin)  
Table C-32 Parallel I/F Connector pin assignment (25-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
STROB-P5N  
BPDB01-P5P  
BPDB03-P5P  
BPDB05-P5P  
BPDB07-P5P  
BUSY-P5P  
SELCT-P5P  
ERROR-P5N  
SLIN-P5N  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
2
Signal Name  
BPDB00-P5P  
BPDB02-P5P  
BPDB04-P5P  
BPDB06-P5P  
ACK-P5N  
PE-P5P  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I
1
I
3
I/O  
4
5
I/O  
6
7
I/O  
8
9
I/O  
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
I
I
I
AUTFD-P5N  
PINIT-P5N  
GND  
O
O
-
I
O
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
C.33  
CN4620 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)  
Table C-33 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USB signal4  
USB signal3  
USBPS-E5V  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USB signal2  
USBPS-E5V  
N.C.  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
1
3
5
7
2
4
6
8
I/O  
I/O  
-
GND  
-
C.34  
CN4622 USB I/F Connector 1 (4-pin)  
Table C-34 USB I/F Connector 1 pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USBPS-E5V  
USB signal3  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USB signal2  
USB signal1  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
S-Video Board (FLGCS*)  
C.35  
PJ4610 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)  
Table C-35 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USBP0-S3N  
USBP0-4  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
1
3
5
7
2
4
6
8
USBP0-S3P  
USBP0-5  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
USBP3-S3N  
USBP3-8  
USBP3-S3P  
C.36  
PJ4612 USB I/F Connector 1 (4-pin)  
Table C-36 USB I/F Connector 1 pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USBP0-4&5  
USBP0-S3P  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USBP0-S3N  
USBP0-1  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
C.37  
PJ4611 USB I/F Connector 2 (4-pin)  
Table C-37 USB I/F Connector 2 pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USBP0-4&5  
USBP3-S3P  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USBP3-S3N  
USBP3-8  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
C.38  
PJ5640 System Board I/F Connector (5-pin)  
Table C-38 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (5-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
CHROMA  
I/O  
O
1
3
5
-
-
-
2
4
GND  
GND  
LUMINANCE  
O
C-30  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.39  
PJ5641 S-Video Connector (4-pin)  
Table C-39 S-Video Connector pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
GND  
LUMINANCE  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
GND  
CHROMA  
I/O  
1
3
-
I
2
4
-
I
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Serial Board (FLGSR*)  
C.40  
CN3504 System Board I/F Connector (30-pin)  
Table C-40 System board I/F Connector pin assignment (30-pin)  
Pin No.  
1
Signal Name  
P3V  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
2
Signal name  
P3V  
I/O  
-
3
KRSSDM-P3N  
GND  
O
-
4
N.C.  
-
5
6
N.C.  
-
7
BDSR-P3N  
BRXD-P3P  
BDCD-P3N  
BTXD-P3P  
GND  
I
8
BCTS-P3N  
BRING-P3N  
BDTR-P3N  
BRTS-P3N  
GND  
I
9
I
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
I
11  
13  
15  
17  
19  
21  
23  
25  
27  
29  
I
O
O
-
O
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
N.C.  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
GND  
-
C-32  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
Appendices  
C.41  
CN3440 Serial I/F Connector (9-pin)  
Table C-41 Serial I/F Connector pin assignment (9-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
BDCD-P3N  
BTXD-P3P  
GND  
I/O  
O
I
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
BRXD-P3P  
BRTR-P3N  
BDSR-P3N  
BCTS-P3N  
I/O  
O
I
1
3
5
7
9
2
4
6
8
-
O
O
BRTS-P3N  
BRING-P3N  
I
O
C.42  
CN4630 USB harness I/F Connector (8-pin)  
Table C-42 USB harness I/F connector pin assignment (8-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USB signal4  
USB signal3  
USBPS-E5V  
N.C.  
I/O  
-
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USB signal2  
USBPS-E5V  
N.C.  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
-
1
3
5
7
2
4
6
8
I/O  
I/O  
-
GND  
-
C.43  
CN4632 USB I/F Connector 1 (4-pin)  
Table C-43 USB I/F Connector 1 pin assignment (4-pin)  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
USBPS-E5V  
USB signal3  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
Pin No.  
Signal Name  
USB signal2  
USB signal1  
I/O  
I/O  
I/O  
1
3
2
4
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
C-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. C Pin Assignment  
C-34  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Appendices  
Appendix. D  
Appendix D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Table D-1 Scan codes (set 1 and set 2) (1/4)  
Code set 1  
Make Break  
Code set 2  
Break  
Cap  
No.  
Keytop  
Note  
Make  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
‘ ~  
1 !  
29  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
0A  
0B  
0C  
0D  
A9  
82  
83  
84  
85  
86  
87  
88  
89  
8A  
8B  
8C  
8D  
0E  
16  
1E  
26  
25  
2E  
36  
3D  
3E  
46  
45  
4E  
55  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
0E  
16  
1E  
26  
25  
2E  
36  
3D  
3E  
46  
45  
4E  
55  
2 @  
3 #  
4 $  
5 %  
6 ^  
7 &  
8 *  
*2  
*2  
*2  
9 (  
0 )  
- _  
= +  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
BkSp  
Tab  
Q
0E  
0F  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
13  
19  
1A  
1B  
8E  
8F  
90  
91  
92  
93  
94  
95  
96  
97  
98  
99  
9A  
9B  
66  
0D  
15  
1D  
24  
2D  
2C  
35  
3C  
43  
44  
4D  
54  
5B  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
66  
0D  
15  
1D  
24  
2D  
2C  
35  
3C  
43  
44  
4D  
54  
5B  
W
E
R
T
Y
U
*2  
*2  
*2  
*2  
I
O
P
[ {  
] }  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
D-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Table D-1 Scan codes (set 1 and set 2) (2/4)  
Code set 1  
Code set 2  
Break  
Cap  
Keytop  
Note  
No.  
Make  
Break  
Make  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
\ |  
2B  
3A  
1E  
1F  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
AB  
BA  
9E  
9F  
A0  
A1  
A2  
A3  
A4  
A5  
A6  
A7  
A8  
5D  
58  
1C  
1B  
23  
2B  
34  
33  
3B  
42  
4B  
4C  
52  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
5D  
58  
1C  
1B  
23  
2B  
34  
33  
3B  
42  
4B  
4C  
52  
*5  
Caps Lock  
A
S
D
F
G
H
J
*2  
*2  
*2  
*2  
K
L
; :  
‘ “  
43  
44  
45  
Enter  
1C  
2A  
56  
9C  
AA  
D6  
5A  
12  
61  
F0  
F0  
F0  
5A  
12  
61  
*3  
Shift (L)  
No.102  
key  
46  
47  
48  
49  
50  
51  
52  
53  
54  
55  
Z
X
2C  
2D  
2E  
2F  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
AC  
AD  
AE  
AF  
B0  
B1  
B2  
B3  
B4  
B5  
1A  
22  
21  
2A  
32  
31  
3A  
41  
49  
4A  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
1A  
22  
21  
2A  
32  
31  
3A  
41  
49  
4A  
C
V
B
N
M
*2  
*2  
*2  
*2  
, <  
. >  
/ ?  
57  
Shift (R)  
36  
B6  
59  
F0  
59  
D-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Appendices  
Table D-1 Scan codes (set 1 and set 2) (3/4)  
Code set 1  
Code set 2  
Break  
Cap  
No.  
Keytop  
Note  
Make  
Break  
Make  
58  
Ctrl  
1D  
9D  
14  
F0  
14  
*3  
60  
61  
62  
Alt (L)  
Space  
38  
39  
B8  
B9  
11  
29  
F0  
F0  
11  
29  
11  
*3  
ALT (R)  
E0 38  
E0 B8 E0 11  
E0  
F0  
75  
76  
Ins  
E0 52  
E0 53  
E0 D2 E0 70  
E0 D3 E0 71  
E0  
E0  
F0  
F0  
70  
71  
*1  
*1  
Del  
79  
80  
81  
E0 4B E0 CB E0 6B E0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
6B  
6C  
69  
*1  
*1  
*1  
Home  
End  
E0 47  
E0 4F  
E0 C7 E0 6C E0  
E0 CF E0 69  
E0  
83  
84  
85  
86  
E0 48  
E0 50  
E0 49  
E0 51  
E0 C8 E0 75  
E0 D0 E0 72  
E0  
E0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
75  
72  
7D  
7A  
*1  
*1  
*1  
*1  
PgUp  
PgDn  
E0 C9 E0 7D E0  
E0 D1 E0 7A E0  
89  
E0 4D E0 CD E0 74  
E0  
F0  
74  
*1  
110  
112  
113  
114  
115  
116  
117  
118  
119  
120  
121  
Esc  
F1  
F2  
F3  
F4  
F5  
F6  
F7  
F8  
F9  
F10  
01  
3B  
3C  
3D  
3E  
3F  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
81  
BB  
BC  
BD  
BE  
BF  
C0  
C1  
C2  
C3  
C4  
76  
05  
06  
04  
0C  
03  
0B  
83  
0A  
01  
09  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
76  
05  
06  
04  
0C  
03  
0B  
83  
0A  
01  
09  
*3  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
D-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Table D-1 Scan codes (set 1 and set 2) (4/4)  
Cap  
No.  
Code set 1  
Make Break  
Code set 2  
Break  
Keytop  
Note  
Make  
78  
122  
123  
124  
F11  
F12  
57  
58  
*6  
D7  
D8  
*6  
F0  
F0  
*6  
78  
07  
*3  
*3  
*6  
07  
*6  
PrintSc  
126  
Pause  
*7  
*7  
*7  
*7  
*7  
*4  
202  
203  
204  
Fn  
1F E0  
2F E0  
Win  
App  
E0  
E0  
5B E0 DB E0  
5D E0 DD E0  
F0  
F0  
1F  
2F  
Notes:  
1. * Scan codes differ by mode.  
2. * Scan codes differ by overlay function.  
3. * Combined with the Fn key makes different codes.  
4. * Fn key does not generate a code by itself.  
5. * This key corresponds to key No. 42 in a 102-key model.  
6. * Refer to Table D-6, No. 124 key scan code.  
7. * Refer to Table D-7, No. 126 key scan code.  
D-4  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Appendices  
Table D-2 Scan codes with left Shift key  
Cap  
No.  
Key  
top  
Code set 1  
Code set 2  
Make  
Break  
Make  
Break  
55  
75  
76  
79  
80  
81  
83  
84  
85  
86  
89  
203  
204  
/
E0 AA E0 35 E0 B5 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 4A E0 F0 4A E0 12  
E0 AA E0 52 E0 D2 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 70 E0 F0 70 E0 12  
INS  
DEL E0 AA E0 53 E0 D3 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 71 E0 F0 71 E0 12  
E0 AA E0 4B E0 CB E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 6B E0 F0 6B E0 12  
Home E0 AA E0 47 E0 C7 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 6C E0 F0 6C E0 12  
End  
E0 AA E0 4F E0 CF E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 69 E0 F0 69 E0 12  
E0 AA E0 48 E0 C8 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 75 E0 F0 75 E0 12  
E0 AA E0 50 E0 D0 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 72 E0 F0 72 E0 12  
PgUp E0 AA E0 49 E0 C9 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 7D E0 F0 7D E0 12  
PgDn E0 AA E0 51 E0 D1 E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 7A E0 F0 7A E0 12  
E0 AA E0 4D E0 CD E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 74 E0 F0 74 E0 12  
E0 AA E0 5B E0 DB E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 1F E0 F0 1F E0 12  
E0 AA E0 5D E0 DD E0 2A E0 F0 12 E0 2F E0 F0 2F E0 12  
Win  
App  
Note : The table above shows scan codes with the left Shift key. In combination with  
the right Shift key, scan codes are changed as listed below:  
With left Shift  
With right Shift  
Set 1  
Set 2  
E0 AA ___________E0 B6  
E0 2A ____________E0 36  
E0 F0 12 _________E0 F0 59  
E0 12 ____________E0 59  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
D-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Table D-3 Scan codes in Numlock mode  
Cap  
No.  
Key  
Code set 1  
Code set 2  
top  
Make  
Break  
Make  
Break  
75  
76  
INS  
DEL  
E0 2A E0 52 E0 D2 E0 AA E0 12 E0 70 E0 F0 70 E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 53 E0 D3 E0 AA E0 12 E0 71 E0 F0 71 E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 4B E0 CB E0 AA E0 12 E0 6B E0 F0 6B E0 F0 12  
79  
80  
Home E0 2A E0 47 E0 C7 E0 AA E0 12 E0 6C E0 F0 6C E0 F0 12  
81  
End  
E0 2A E0 4F E0 CF E0 AA E0 12 E0 69 E0 F0 69 E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 48 E0 C8 E0 AA E0 12 E0 75 E0 F0 75 E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 50 E0 D0 E0 AA E0 12 E0 72 E0 F0 72 E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 49 E0 C9 E0 AA E0 12 E0 7D E0 F0 7D E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 51 E0 D1 E0 AA E0 12 E0 7A E0 F0 7A E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 4D E0 CD E0 AA E0 12 E0 74 E0 F0 74 E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 5B E0 DB E0 AA E0 12 E0 1F E0 F0 1F E0 F0 12  
E0 2A E0 5D E0 DD E0 AA E0 12 E0 2F E0 F0 2F E0 F0 12  
83  
84  
85  
PgUp  
PgDn  
86  
89  
203  
204  
Win  
App  
Table D-4 Scan codes with Fn key  
Cap  
Code set 1  
Make Break  
Code set 2  
Break  
No.  
Keytop  
Make  
5A  
43  
58  
ENT  
CTRL  
E0  
E0  
E0  
1C  
1D  
38  
E0  
E0  
E0  
9C  
9D  
B8  
E0  
E0  
E0  
E0  
E0  
E0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
5A  
14  
11  
14  
11  
60  
LALT  
121  
122  
123  
ARROW  
45  
45  
46  
C5  
77  
77  
7E  
F0  
F0  
F0  
77  
77  
7E  
NUMERIC  
Scrl  
C5  
C5  
D-6  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Appendices  
Table D-5 Scan codes in overlay mode  
Code set 1  
Break  
Code set 2  
Break  
Cap  
No.  
Keytop  
(8)  
Make  
Make  
09  
10  
11  
23  
24  
25  
26  
37  
38  
39  
40  
52  
54  
55  
8
9
0
U
I
48  
49  
37  
4B  
4C  
4D  
4A  
4F  
50  
51  
4E  
52  
53  
C8  
C9  
B7  
CB  
CC  
CD  
CA  
CF  
D0  
D1  
CE  
D2  
D3  
75  
7D  
7C  
6B  
73  
74  
7B  
69  
72  
7A  
79  
70  
71  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
F0  
75  
7D  
7C  
6B  
73  
74  
7B  
69  
72  
7A  
79  
70  
71  
4A  
(9)  
(*)  
(4)  
(5)  
(6)  
(–)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(+)  
(0)  
(.)  
O
P
J
K
L
;
M
.
/
(/)  
E0  
35  
E0  
B5  
40  
4A  
E0  
F0  
Table D-6 No.124 key scan code  
Key  
top  
Code set 1  
Code set 2  
Shift  
Make  
Break  
Make  
Break  
Prt Sc Common E0 2A E0 37 E0 B7 E0 AA E0 12 E0 7C E0 F0 7C E0 F0 12  
E0 37  
E0 37  
54  
E0 B7  
E0 B7  
D4  
E0 7C  
E0 7C  
84  
E0 F0 7C  
E0 F0 7C  
F0 B4  
Ctrl +  
Shift +  
Alt +  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
D-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. D Keyboard Scan/Character Codes  
Table D-7 No.126 key scan code  
Key  
top  
Shift  
Code set 1  
Make  
Code set 2  
Make  
Pause Common E1 1D 45 E1 9D C5 E1 14 77 E1 F0 14  
*
F0 77  
Ctrl*  
E0 46 E0 C6  
E0 7E E0 F0 7E  
*: This key generates only make codes.  
D-8  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. E Key Layout  
Appendices  
Appendix. E  
Key Layout  
Appendix E Key Layout  
E.1  
Keyboard Layout  
Figure E-1 Keyboard layout (for UK)  
Figure E-2 Keyboard layout (for US)  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
E-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. E Key Layout  
E-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. F Wiring Diagrams  
Appendices  
Appendix. F  
Appendix F Wiring Diagrams  
F.1  
RGB Monitor ID Wraparound Connector (15-pin to 15-pin)  
Figure F-1 RGB monitor ID wraparound connector  
F.2  
Parallel Port Wraparound Connector  
Figure F-2 Parallel port wraparound connector  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
F-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. F Wiring Diagrams  
F-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. G BIOS/KBC/EC Update  
Appendices  
Appendix. G  
BIOS Rewrite Procedures  
Appendix G BIOS/KBC/EC Update  
To update the BIOS, KBC or EC, insert the FD for update into the FDD. Then turn on the  
power of the computer while pressing the following key until the power LED blinks.  
For BIOS update:  
~
(tilde key ; See the following pictures.)  
(US)  
(UK)  
For KBC or EC update: Tab  
When the update is completed, the message will appear and the beep will sound. Then the  
power of the computer is turned off.  
Make sure of the update using the T&D.  
NOTE: Do not turn off the power of the computer during update. Otherwise the  
computer may not start again.  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
G-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. G BIOS/KBC/EC Update  
G-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix. H Reliability  
Appendices  
Appendix. H  
Reliability  
Appendix H Reliability  
The following table shows the MTBF (Mean Time Between Failures) of system.  
Table H-1 MTBF  
Component  
Time (hours)  
6,811  
System (maximum configuration)  
System (minimum configuration )  
6,822  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
H-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendices  
Appendix. H Reliability  
H-2  
[CONFIDENTIAL]  
Satellite A50S/TECRA A3X Maintenance Manual (960-534)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Technika Flat Panel Television 23 231 BB User Manual
Techno Source Handheld Game System 90665 User Manual
Toshiba Computer Drive MK4021GAS User Manual
Toshiba Projection Television P600DL User Manual
Toshiba Projection Television TP 50H60 User Manual
Transcend Information Computer Hardware CF 300X User Manual
TRENDnet Switch TK 1603R User Manual
ViewSonic Flat Panel Television VPW4255 User Manual
Vizio Flat Panel Television M651d A2 User Manual
Volvo Car Stereo System 1997 850 User Manual